Linux Audio

Check our new training course

Loading...
v6.2
   1/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
   2/*
   3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   4 *
   5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   6 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   7 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   8 * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
  10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2022 Intel Corporation
  11 */
  12
  13#ifndef MAC80211_H
  14#define MAC80211_H
  15
  16#include <linux/bug.h>
  17#include <linux/kernel.h>
  18#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  19#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  20#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  21#include <linux/lockdep.h>
  22#include <net/cfg80211.h>
  23#include <net/codel.h>
  24#include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
  25#include <asm/unaligned.h>
  26
  27/**
  28 * DOC: Introduction
  29 *
  30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  33 * drivers.
  34 */
  35
  36/**
  37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  38 *
  39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  44 * tasklet function.
  45 *
  46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  47 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  48 */
  49
  50/**
  51 * DOC: Warning
  52 *
  53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  55 */
  56
  57/**
  58 * DOC: Frame format
  59 *
  60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  63 * hardware.
  64 *
  65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  66 *
  67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  69 *
  70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
  72 */
  73
  74/**
  75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  76 *
  77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  81 *
  82 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  83 * suspend.
  84 *
  85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  86 *
  87 */
  88
  89/**
  90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
  91 *
  92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
  93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
  94 * different stations/interfaces.
  95 *
  96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
  97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
  98 * handler.
  99 *
 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
 103 *
 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
 106 *
 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
 109 * driver op.
 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
 113 *
 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
 118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
 119 *
 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
 124 * .release_buffered_frames().
 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
 128 */
 129
 130/**
 131 * DOC: HW timestamping
 132 *
 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
 135 *
 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
 140 *
 141 * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
 145 */
 146struct device;
 147
 148/**
 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
 150 *
 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
 153 */
 154enum ieee80211_max_queues {
 155	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
 156	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
 157};
 158
 159#define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
 160
 161/**
 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 167 */
 168enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 169	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 170	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 171	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 172	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 173};
 174
 175/**
 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 177 *
 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 180 *
 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 183 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
 190 */
 191struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 192	u16 txop;
 193	u16 cw_min;
 194	u16 cw_max;
 195	u8 aifs;
 196	bool acm;
 197	bool uapsd;
 198	bool mu_edca;
 199	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
 200};
 201
 202struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 203	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 204	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 205	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 206	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 207};
 208
 209/**
 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
 215 *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
 
 
 
 
 217 */
 218enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
 219	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
 220	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
 221	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
 222	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
 223	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 224};
 225
 226/**
 227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
 228 *
 229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
 230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
 231 *
 232 * @def: the channel definition
 233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
 
 
 234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
 235 *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
 236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
 237 *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
 238 *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
 239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
 240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 241 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 242 */
 243struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
 244	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
 245	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
 
 246
 247	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
 248
 249	bool radar_enabled;
 250
 251	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
 252};
 253
 254/**
 255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
 256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
 257 *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
 258 *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
 259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
 260 *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
 261 *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
 262 *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
 263 *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
 264 *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
 265 *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
 266 *      for changes/removal.)
 267 */
 268enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
 269	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
 270	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
 271};
 272
 273/**
 274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
 275 *
 276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
 277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
 278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
 279 * done.
 280 *
 281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
 282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
 283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
 284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
 285 */
 286struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
 287	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 288	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
 289	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
 290	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
 291};
 292
 293/**
 294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 295 *
 296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
 297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
 298 *
 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 300 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 308 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 310 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 312 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 317 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
 320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
 324 *	changed
 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
 326 *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
 328 *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
 329 *	context had been assigned.
 330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
 332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
 333 *	keep alive) changed.
 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
 336 *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 342 *	status changed.
 343 *
 
 344 */
 345enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 346	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 347	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 348	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 349	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 350	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
 351	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 352	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 353	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 354	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 355	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 356	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 357	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 358	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 359	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 360	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 361	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
 362	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
 363	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
 364	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
 365	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
 366	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
 367	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
 368	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
 369	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
 370	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
 371	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
 372	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
 373	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
 374	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
 375	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
 376	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
 377	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
 
 
 378
 379	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 380};
 381
 382/*
 383 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 384 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 385 * filtering will be disabled.
 386 */
 387#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 388
 389/**
 390 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
 391 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
 392 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
 393 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
 394 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
 395 *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
 396 *	once each time the timeout triggers.
 397 */
 398enum ieee80211_event_type {
 399	RSSI_EVENT,
 400	MLME_EVENT,
 401	BAR_RX_EVENT,
 402	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
 403};
 404
 405/**
 406 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
 407 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
 408 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
 409 */
 410enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
 411	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 412	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 413};
 414
 415/**
 416 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
 417 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
 418 */
 419struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
 420	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
 421};
 422
 423/**
 424 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 425 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
 426 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
 427 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
 428 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
 429 */
 430enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
 431	AUTH_EVENT,
 432	ASSOC_EVENT,
 433	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
 434	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
 435};
 436
 437/**
 438 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 439 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
 440 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
 441 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
 442 */
 443enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
 444	MLME_SUCCESS,
 445	MLME_DENIED,
 446	MLME_TIMEOUT,
 447};
 448
 449/**
 450 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
 451 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
 452 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
 453 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
 454 */
 455struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
 456	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
 457	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
 458	u16 reason;
 459};
 460
 461/**
 462 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
 463 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
 464 * @tid: the tid
 465 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
 466 */
 467struct ieee80211_ba_event {
 468	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 469	u16 tid;
 470	u16 ssn;
 471};
 472
 473/**
 474 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
 475 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
 476 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
 477 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
 478 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
 479 * @u:union holding the fields above
 480 */
 481struct ieee80211_event {
 482	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
 483	union {
 484		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
 485		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
 486		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
 487	} u;
 488};
 489
 490/**
 491 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
 492 *
 493 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
 494 *
 495 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 496 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 497 */
 498struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
 499	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
 500	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
 501};
 502
 503/**
 504 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
 505 *
 506 * @lci: LCI subelement content
 507 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
 508 * @lci_len: LCI data length
 509 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
 510 */
 511struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
 512	const u8 *lci;
 513	const u8 *civicloc;
 514	size_t lci_len;
 515	size_t civicloc_len;
 516};
 517
 518/**
 519 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
 520 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
 521 *
 522 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 523 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 524 */
 525struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
 526	u32 min_interval;
 527	u32 max_interval;
 528};
 529
 530/**
 531 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 532 *
 533 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 534 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 535 *
 
 
 
 
 
 536 * @addr: (link) address used locally
 537 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
 538 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
 539 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
 540 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
 541 *	ACK, BACK or both
 542 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
 543 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
 544 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
 545 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 546 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 547 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 548 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 549 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
 550 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
 551 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 552 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
 553 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
 554 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 555 *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
 556 *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
 557 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
 558 *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
 559 *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
 560 *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
 561 *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
 562 *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 563 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
 564 *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
 565 *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 566 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
 567 *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
 568 *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
 569 *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
 570 *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
 571 *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
 572 *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
 573 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 574 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 575 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 576 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 577 *	the current band.
 578 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
 579 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 580 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 581 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 582 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 583 *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
 584 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
 585 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
 586 *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
 587 *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
 588 *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
 589 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 590 *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
 591 *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
 592 *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
 593 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
 594 *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
 595 *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
 596 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
 597 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 598 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 599 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
 600 * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
 601 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
 602 *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
 603 *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
 604 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
 605 *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
 606 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
 607 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
 608 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
 609 *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
 610 *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
 611 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
 612 *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
 613 *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
 614 *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
 615 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
 616 *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
 617 *	station.
 618 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
 619 *	responder functionality.
 620 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
 621 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
 622 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
 623 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
 624 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
 625 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
 626 *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
 627 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
 628 *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
 629 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
 630 *	connected to (STA)
 631 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
 632 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
 633 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
 634 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 635 *	interval.
 636 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
 637 *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
 638 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
 639 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
 640 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
 641 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
 642 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
 643 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
 644 *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
 645 *	for read access.
 646 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
 647 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
 648 *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
 649 *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
 650 *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
 651 *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
 652 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
 653 *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
 654 *	for read access.
 655 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 656 */
 657struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 
 
 
 658	const u8 *bssid;
 659	unsigned int link_id;
 660	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
 661	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
 662	bool uora_exists;
 663	u8 uora_ocw_range;
 664	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
 665	bool he_support;
 666	bool twt_requester;
 667	bool twt_responder;
 668	bool twt_protected;
 669	bool twt_broadcast;
 670	/* erp related data */
 671	bool use_cts_prot;
 672	bool use_short_preamble;
 673	bool use_short_slot;
 674	bool enable_beacon;
 675	u8 dtim_period;
 676	u16 beacon_int;
 677	u16 assoc_capability;
 678	u64 sync_tsf;
 679	u32 sync_device_ts;
 680	u8 sync_dtim_count;
 681	u32 basic_rates;
 682	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
 683	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 684	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 685	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 686	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 687	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
 688	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
 689	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
 690	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
 691	bool qos;
 692	bool hidden_ssid;
 693	int txpower;
 694	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
 695	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
 696	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
 697	u16 max_idle_period;
 698	bool protected_keep_alive;
 699	bool ftm_responder;
 700	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
 701	/* Multiple BSSID data */
 702	bool nontransmitted;
 703	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
 704	u8 bssid_index;
 705	u8 bssid_indicator;
 706	bool ema_ap;
 707	u8 profile_periodicity;
 708	struct {
 709		u32 params;
 710		u16 nss_set;
 711	} he_oper;
 712	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
 713	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
 714	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
 715	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
 716	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
 717	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
 718	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
 719	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
 720	u8 pwr_reduction;
 721	bool eht_support;
 722
 723	bool csa_active;
 
 724	bool mu_mimo_owner;
 725	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
 726
 727	bool color_change_active;
 728	u8 color_change_color;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 729};
 730
 731/**
 732 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 733 *
 734 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 735 *
 736 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 737 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 738 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 739 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 740 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 741 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 742 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 743 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 744 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 745 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 746 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 747 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 748 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 749 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 750 *	station
 751 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 752 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 753 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 754 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 755 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 756 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 757 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 758 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 759 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 760 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 761 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 762 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 763 *	hardware queue.
 764 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 765 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 766 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 767 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 768 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 769 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 770 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 771 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 772 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
 773 *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
 774 *	off-channel operation.
 775 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
 776 *	(header conversion)
 777 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 778 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 779 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 780 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 781 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
 782 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
 783 *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
 784 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 785 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 786 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 787 *	queue gets full.
 788 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 789 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 790 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 791 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
 792 *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
 793 *	should kick the MLME state machine.
 794 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 795 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 796 *	status to user space)
 797 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 798 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 799 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 800 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 801 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 802 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 803 *	handled properly by the device.
 804 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 805 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 806 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 807 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
 808 *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
 809 *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
 810 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
 811 *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
 812 *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
 813 *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
 814 *	PS-Poll responses.
 815 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
 816 *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
 817 *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
 818 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
 819 *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
 820 *	monitor injection).
 821 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
 822 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
 823 *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
 824 *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
 825 *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
 826 *
 827 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 828 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 829 */
 830enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
 831	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 832	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 833	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 834	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 835	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 836	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 837	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 838	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 839	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 840	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 841	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 842	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 843	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 844	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
 845	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
 846	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 847	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 848	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
 849	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 850	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 851	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
 852	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 853	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 854	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 855	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 856	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 857	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
 858	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
 859	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
 860	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
 861	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
 862};
 863
 864#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 865
 866#define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
 867
 868/**
 869 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
 870 *
 871 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
 872 *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
 873 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
 874 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
 875 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
 876 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
 877 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
 878 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
 879 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 880 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 881 *	it can be sent out.
 882 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
 883 *	has already been assigned to this frame.
 884 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
 885 *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
 886 *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
 887 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
 888 *	for sequence number assignment
 
 
 889 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
 890 *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
 891 *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
 892 *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
 893 *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
 894 *	it's intended for an MLD.
 895 *
 896 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
 897 */
 898enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
 899	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
 900	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
 901	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
 902	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
 903	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
 904	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
 905	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
 906	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
 907	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
 908	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
 
 909	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
 910};
 911
 912#define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
 913#define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
 914	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
 915			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
 916
 917/**
 918 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
 919 *
 920 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
 921 *
 922 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
 923 */
 924enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
 925	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
 926};
 927
 928/*
 929 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
 930 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
 931 */
 932#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
 933	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
 934	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
 935	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
 936	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
 937	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
 938	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
 939	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
 940
 941/**
 942 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
 943 *	Rate Control algorithm.
 944 *
 945 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
 946 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
 947 *
 948 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
 949 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
 950 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
 951 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
 952 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
 953 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
 954 *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
 955 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
 956 *	Greenfield mode.
 957 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
 958 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
 959 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
 960 *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
 961 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
 962 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
 963 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
 964 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
 965 */
 966enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
 967	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
 968	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
 969	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
 970
 971	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
 972	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
 973	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
 974	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
 975	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
 976	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
 977	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
 978	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
 979	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
 980};
 981
 982
 983/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
 984#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
 985
 986/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
 987#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
 988
 989/* maximum number of rate stages */
 990#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
 991
 992/* maximum number of rate table entries */
 993#define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
 994
 995/**
 996 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
 997 *
 998 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
 999 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1000 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1001 *
1002 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1003 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1004 *
1005 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1006 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1007 *
1008 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1009 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1010 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1011 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1012 * information::
1013 *
1014 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1015 *
1016 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1017 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1018 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1019 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1020 * information should then contain::
1021 *
1022 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1023 *
1024 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1025 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1026 */
1027struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1028	s8 idx;
1029	u16 count:5,
1030	    flags:11;
1031} __packed;
1032
1033#define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1034
 
 
 
 
 
1035static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1036					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1037{
1038	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1039	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1040	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1041}
1042
1043static inline u8
1044ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1045{
1046	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1047}
1048
1049static inline u8
1050ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1051{
1052	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1053}
1054
1055/**
1056 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1057 *
1058 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1059 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1060 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1061 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1062 *
1063 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1064 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1065 *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1066 *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1067 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1068 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
 
 
1069 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1070 * @control: union part for control data
1071 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1072 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1073 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1074 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1075 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1076 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1077 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1078 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1079 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1080 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1081 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1082 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1083 * @pad: padding
1084 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1085 * @status: union part for status data
1086 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1087 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1088 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1089 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1090 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1091 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1092 *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1093 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1094 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1095 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1096 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1097 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1098 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1099 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1100 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1101 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1102 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1103 */
1104struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1105	/* common information */
1106	u32 flags;
1107	u32 band:3,
1108	    ack_frame_id:13,
 
1109	    hw_queue:4,
1110	    tx_time_est:10;
1111	/* 2 free bits */
1112
1113	union {
1114		struct {
1115			union {
1116				/* rate control */
1117				struct {
1118					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1119						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1120					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1121					u8 use_rts:1;
1122					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1123					u8 short_preamble:1;
1124					u8 skip_table:1;
1125					/* 2 bytes free */
 
 
 
 
1126				};
1127				/* only needed before rate control */
1128				unsigned long jiffies;
1129			};
1130			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1131			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1132			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1133			u32 flags;
1134			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1135		} control;
1136		struct {
1137			u64 cookie;
1138		} ack;
1139		struct {
1140			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1141			s32 ack_signal;
1142			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1143			u8 ampdu_len;
1144			u8 antenna;
 
1145			u16 tx_time;
1146			u8 flags;
1147			void *status_driver_data[18 / sizeof(void *)];
 
1148		} status;
1149		struct {
1150			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1151				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1152			u8 pad[4];
1153
1154			void *rate_driver_data[
1155				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1156		};
1157		void *driver_data[
1158			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1159	};
1160};
1161
1162static inline u16
1163ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1164{
1165	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1166	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1167	 */
1168	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1169	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1170}
1171
1172static inline u16
1173ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1174{
1175	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1176}
1177
1178/***
1179 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1180 *
1181 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1182 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1183 *
1184 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1185 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1186 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1187 * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1188 * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1189 */
1190struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1191	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1192	u8 try_count;
1193	u8 tx_power_idx;
1194};
1195
1196/**
1197 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1198 *
1199 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1200 * @info: Basic tx status information
1201 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1202 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1203 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1204 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1205 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1206 *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1207 *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1208 */
1209struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1210	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1211	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1212	struct sk_buff *skb;
1213	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1214	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1215	u8 n_rates;
1216
1217	struct list_head *free_list;
1218};
1219
1220/**
1221 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1222 *
1223 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1224 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1225 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1226 *
1227 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1228 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1229 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1230 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1231 */
1232struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1233	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1234	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1235	const u8 *common_ies;
1236	size_t common_ie_len;
1237};
1238
1239
1240static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1241{
1242	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1243}
1244
1245static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1246{
1247	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1248}
1249
1250/**
1251 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1252 *
1253 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1254 *
1255 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1256 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1257 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1258 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1259 *
1260 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1261 *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1262 *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1263 */
1264static inline void
1265ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1266{
1267	int i;
1268
1269	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1270		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1271	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1272		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1273	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1274	/* clear the rate counts */
1275	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1276		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1277	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1278}
1279
1280
1281/**
1282 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1283 *
1284 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1285 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1286 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1287 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1288 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1289 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1290 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1291 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1292 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1293 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1294 *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1295 *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1296 *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1297 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1298 *	de-duplication by itself.
1299 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1300 *	the frame.
1301 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1302 *	the frame.
 
 
 
1303 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1304 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1305 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1306 *	merging.
1307 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1308 *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1309 *	(including FCS) was received.
1310 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1311 *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
 
 
 
 
 
1312 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1313 *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1314 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1315 *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1316 *	each A-MPDU
1317 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1318 *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1319 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1320 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1321 *	on this subframe
1322 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1323 *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1324 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1325 *	done by the hardware
1326 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1327 *	processing it in any regular way.
1328 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1329 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1330 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1331 *	monitor interfaces.
1332 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1333 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1334 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1335 *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1336 *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1337 *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1338 *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1339 *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1340 *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1341 *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1342 *	interleaved with other frames.
1343 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1344 *	radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1345 *	the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
 
 
 
1346 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1347 *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1348 *	the first subframe.
1349 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1350 *	be done in the hardware.
1351 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1352 *	frame
1353 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1354 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1355 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1356 *	
1357 *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1358 *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1359 *	 - DATA3_CODING
1360 *	 - DATA5_GI
1361 *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1362 *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1363 *	 - DATA3_STBC
1364 *	
1365 *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1366 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1367 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1368 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1369 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1370 *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1371 *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1372 *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1373 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1374 *	hardware or driver)
1375 */
1376enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1377	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1378	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1379	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1380	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1381	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1382	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1383	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1384	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1385	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1386	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1387	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1388	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1389	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1390	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1391	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1392	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1393	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1394	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
 
 
1395	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1396	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1397	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA	= BIT(20),
1398	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1399	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1400	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1401	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1402	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1403	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1404	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1405	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1406	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1407	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1408};
1409
1410/**
1411 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1412 *
1413 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1414 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1415 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1416 *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1417 *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1418 *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1419 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1420 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1421 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1422 */
1423enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1424	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1425	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1426	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1427	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1428	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1429	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1430};
1431
1432#define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1433
1434enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1435	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1436	RX_ENC_HT,
1437	RX_ENC_VHT,
1438	RX_ENC_HE,
 
1439};
1440
1441/**
1442 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1443 *
1444 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1445 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1446 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1447 *
1448 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1449 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1450 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1451 *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1452 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1453 *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1454 *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1455 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1456 *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1457 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1458 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1459 *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1460 *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1461 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1462 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1463 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1464 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1465 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1466 *	values were filled.
1467 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1468 *	support dB or unspecified units)
1469 * @antenna: antenna used
1470 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1471 *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1472 * @nss: number of streams (VHT and HE only)
1473 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1474 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1475 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1476 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1477 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1478 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1479 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
 
 
 
1480 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1481 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1482 *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1483 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1484 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1485 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1486 *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1487 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1488 *	@link_valid.
1489 */
1490struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1491	u64 mactime;
1492	union {
1493		u64 boottime_ns;
1494		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1495	};
1496	u32 device_timestamp;
1497	u32 ampdu_reference;
1498	u32 flag;
1499	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1500	u8 enc_flags;
1501	u8 encoding:2, bw:3, he_ru:3;
1502	u8 he_gi:2, he_dcm:1;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1503	u8 rate_idx;
1504	u8 nss;
1505	u8 rx_flags;
1506	u8 band;
1507	u8 antenna;
1508	s8 signal;
1509	u8 chains;
1510	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1511	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1512	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1513	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1514};
1515
1516static inline u32
1517ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1518{
1519	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1520	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1521}
1522
1523/**
1524 * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1525 * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1526 *	(this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1527 *	 bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1528 * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1529 *	alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1530 *	description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1531 *	Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1532 * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1533 * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1534 * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1535 *	then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1536 *	@data field.
1537 * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1538 *	the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1539 *	length
1540 * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1541 *
1542 * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1543 * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1544 * data.
1545 */
1546struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1547	u32 present;
1548	u8 align;
1549	u8 oui[3];
1550	u8 subns;
1551	u8 pad;
1552	u16 len;
1553	u8 data[];
1554} __packed;
1555
1556/**
1557 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1558 *
1559 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1560 *
1561 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1562 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1563 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1564 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1565 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1566 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1567 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1568 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1569 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1570 *	for more.
1571 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1572 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1573 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1574 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1575 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1576 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1577 *	operating channel.
1578 */
1579enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1580	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1581	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1582	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1583	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1584};
1585
1586
1587/**
1588 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1589 *
1590 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1591 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1592 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1593 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1594 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1595 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1596 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1597 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1598 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1599 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1600 */
1601enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1602	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1603	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1604	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1605	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1606	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1607	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1608	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1609	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1610};
1611
1612/**
1613 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1614 *
1615 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1616 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1617 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1618 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1619 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1620 */
1621enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1622	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1623	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1624	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1625	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1626
1627	/* keep last */
1628	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1629};
1630
1631/**
1632 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1633 *
1634 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1635 *
1636 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1637 *
1638 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1639 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1640 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1641 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1642 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1643 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1644 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1645 *
1646 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1647 *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1648 *
1649 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1650 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1651 *
1652 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1653 *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1654 *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1655 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1656 *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1657 *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1658 *
1659 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1660 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1661 *	configured for an HT channel.
1662 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1663 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1664 */
1665struct ieee80211_conf {
1666	u32 flags;
1667	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1668
1669	u16 listen_interval;
1670	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1671
1672	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1673
1674	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1675	bool radar_enabled;
1676	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1677};
1678
1679/**
1680 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1681 *
1682 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1683 * operation.
1684 *
1685 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1686 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1687 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1688 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1689 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1690 *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1691 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1692 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1693 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1694 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1695 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1696  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1697  *	channel, expressed in TU.
 
1698 */
1699struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1700	u64 timestamp;
1701	u32 device_timestamp;
1702	bool block_tx;
1703	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1704	u8 count;
 
1705	u32 delay;
1706};
1707
1708/**
1709 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1710 *
1711 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1712 *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1713 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1714 *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1715 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1716 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1717 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1718 *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1719 *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1720 *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1721 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1722 *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1723 *	this is not pure P2P vif.
 
 
 
 
 
 
1724 */
1725enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1726	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1727	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1728	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1729	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
 
 
1730};
1731
1732
1733/**
1734 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1735 *
1736 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1737 *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1738 *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1739 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1740 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1741 *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1742 *	mac80211.
1743 */
1744
1745enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1746	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1747	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1748	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1749};
1750
1751/**
1752 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1753 * @assoc: association status
1754 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1755 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1756 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1757 *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1758 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
 
 
 
 
 
1759 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1760 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1761 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1762 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1763 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1764 *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1765 *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1766 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1767 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1768 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1769 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1770 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1771 *	your driver/device needs to do.
1772 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1773 *	(station mode only)
1774 */
1775struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1776	/* association related data */
1777	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1778	bool ibss_creator;
1779	bool ps;
1780	u16 aid;
 
 
 
1781
1782	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1783	int arp_addr_cnt;
1784	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1785	size_t ssid_len;
1786	bool s1g;
1787	bool idle;
1788	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1789};
1790
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1791/**
1792 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1793 *
1794 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1795 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1796 *
1797 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1798 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1799 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1800 *	or the BSS we're associated to
1801 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1802 *	indexed by link ID
1803 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1804 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1805 *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1806 *	API calls meant for that purpose.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1807 * @addr: address of this interface
1808 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1809 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1810 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1811 *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1812 *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1813 *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1814 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1815 *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1816 *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1817 *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1818 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1819 *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1820 *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1821 *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1822 *	restrictions.
1823 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1824 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1825 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1826 *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1827 *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1828 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1829 *	interface.
1830 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1831 *	for this interface.
1832 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1833 *	sizeof(void \*).
1834 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1835 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1836 *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1837 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1838 */
1839struct ieee80211_vif {
1840	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1841	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1842	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1843	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1844	u16 valid_links, active_links;
 
1845	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1846	bool p2p;
1847
1848	u8 cab_queue;
1849	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1850
1851	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1852
1853	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1854	u32 driver_flags;
1855	u32 offload_flags;
1856
1857#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1858	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1859#endif
1860
1861	bool probe_req_reg;
1862	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1863
1864	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1865
1866	/* must be last */
1867	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1868};
1869
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1870#define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1871	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1872		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1873		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1874		    (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1875
1876static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1877{
1878#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1879	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1880#endif
1881	return false;
1882}
1883
1884/**
1885 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1886 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1887 *
1888 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1889 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1890 *
1891 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1892 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1893 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1894 */
1895struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1896
1897/**
1898 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1899 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1900 *
1901 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1902 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1903 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1904 */
1905struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1906
1907/**
1908 * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1909 * @vif: the interface to check
1910 */
1911static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1912{
1913	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1914}
1915
1916#define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1917	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1918				  lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1919
1920#define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1921	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1922			      lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1923
1924/**
1925 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1926 *
1927 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1928 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1929 *
1930 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1931 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1932 *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1933 *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1934 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1935 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1936 *	generation in software.
1937 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1938 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1939 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1940 *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1941 *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1942 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1943 *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1944 *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1945 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1946 *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1947 *	MIC.
1948 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1949 *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1950 *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1951 *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1952 *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1953 *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1954 *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1955 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1956 *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1957 *	only for management frames (MFP).
1958 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1959 *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1960 *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
1961 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
1962 *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
1963 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
1964 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
1965 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
1966 *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
1967 *	generation only
 
 
1968 */
1969enum ieee80211_key_flags {
1970	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
1971	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
1972	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
1973	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
1974	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
1975	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
1976	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
1977	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
1978	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
1979	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
1980	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
 
1981};
1982
1983/**
1984 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
1985 *
1986 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
1987 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
1988 *
1989 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
1990 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
1991 *	encrypted in hardware.
1992 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
1993 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
1994 *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
1995 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
1996 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
1997 * @keylen: key material length
1998 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
1999 * 	data block:
2000 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2001 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2002 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2003 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2004 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2005 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2006 */
2007struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2008	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2009	u32 cipher;
2010	u8 icv_len;
2011	u8 iv_len;
2012	u8 hw_key_idx;
2013	s8 keyidx;
2014	u16 flags;
2015	s8 link_id;
2016	u8 keylen;
2017	u8 key[];
2018};
2019
2020#define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2021
2022#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2023#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2024
2025/**
2026 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2027 *
2028 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2029 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2030 *	reverse order than in packet)
2031 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2032 *	reverse order than in packet)
2033 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2034 *	reverse order than in packet)
2035 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2036 *	reverse order than in packet)
2037 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2038 */
2039struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2040	union {
2041		struct {
2042			u32 iv32;
2043			u16 iv16;
2044		} tkip;
2045		struct {
2046			u8 pn[6];
2047		} ccmp;
2048		struct {
2049			u8 pn[6];
2050		} aes_cmac;
2051		struct {
2052			u8 pn[6];
2053		} aes_gmac;
2054		struct {
2055			u8 pn[6];
2056		} gcmp;
2057		struct {
2058			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2059			u8 seq_len;
2060		} hw;
2061	};
2062};
2063
2064/**
2065 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2066 *
2067 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2068 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2069 *
2070 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2071 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2072 */
2073enum set_key_cmd {
2074	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2075};
2076
2077/**
2078 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2079 *
2080 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2081 *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2082 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2083 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2084 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2085 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2086 */
2087enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2088	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2089	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2090	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2091	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2092	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2093	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2094};
2095
2096/**
2097 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2098 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2099 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2100 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2101 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2102 *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2103 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2104 *
2105 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2106 *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2107 */
2108enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2109	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2110	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2111	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2112	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2113	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2114};
2115
2116/**
2117 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2118 *
2119 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2120 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2121 *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2122 */
2123struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2124	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2125	struct {
2126		s8 idx;
2127		u8 count;
2128		u8 count_cts;
2129		u8 count_rts;
2130		u16 flags;
2131	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2132};
2133
2134/**
2135 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2136 *
2137 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2138 *
2139 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2140 *	to the STA.
2141 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2142 *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2143 *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2144 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2145 *	per peer TPC.
2146 */
2147struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2148	s16 power;
2149	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2150};
2151
2152/**
2153 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2154 *
2155 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2156 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2157 *
2158 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2159 *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2160 *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2161 *
2162 *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2163 *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2164 *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2165 *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2166 *
2167 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2168 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2169 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2170 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2171 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2172 */
2173struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2174	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2175
2176	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2177	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2178};
2179
2180/**
2181 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2182 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2183 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2184 *
2185 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2186 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2187 *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2188 *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2189 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2190 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2191 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2192 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2193 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2194 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2195 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2196 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
 
2197 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2198 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2199 *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2200 *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2201 *	the station moves to associated state.
2202 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2203 *
2204 */
2205struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2206	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2207
2208	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2209	u8 link_id;
2210	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2211
2212	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2213	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2214	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2215	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2216	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2217	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2218
2219	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2220
2221	u8 rx_nss;
2222	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2223	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2224};
2225
2226/**
2227 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2228 *
2229 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2230 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2231 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2232 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2233 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2234 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2235 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2236 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2237 *
2238 * @addr: MAC address
2239 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2240 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2241 *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2242 *	Can be modified by driver.
2243 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2244 *	otherwise always false)
2245 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2246 *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2247 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2248 *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2249 *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2250 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2251 * @rates: rate control selection table
2252 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2253 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2254 *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2255 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2256 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2257 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2258 *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2259 *	unlimited.
2260 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2261 *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2262 *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2263 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2264 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2265 *	is used for non-data frames
2266 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2267 *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2268 *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2269 *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2270 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2271 *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2272 *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2273 *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2274 *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2275 *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2276 *	by the AP.
2277 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
 
2278 */
2279struct ieee80211_sta {
2280	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2281	u16 aid;
2282	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2283	bool wme;
2284	u8 uapsd_queues;
2285	u8 max_sp;
2286	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2287	bool tdls;
2288	bool tdls_initiator;
2289	bool mfp;
2290	bool mlo;
 
2291	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2292
2293	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2294
2295	bool support_p2p_ps;
2296
2297	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2298
2299	u16 valid_links;
2300	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2301	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2302
2303	/* must be last */
2304	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2305};
2306
2307#ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2308bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2309#else
2310static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2311{
2312	return true;
2313}
2314#endif
2315
2316#define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2317	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2318				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2319
2320#define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2321	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2322			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2323
2324#define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2325	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2326		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2327		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2328		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2329
2330/**
2331 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2332 *
2333 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2334 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2335 *
2336 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2337 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2338 */
2339enum sta_notify_cmd {
2340	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2341};
2342
2343/**
2344 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2345 *
2346 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2347 * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2348 */
2349struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2350	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2351};
2352
2353/**
2354 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2355 *
2356 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2357 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2358 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2359 *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2360 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2361 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2362 *
2363 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2364 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2365 */
2366struct ieee80211_txq {
2367	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2368	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2369	u8 tid;
2370	u8 ac;
2371
2372	/* must be last */
2373	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2374};
2375
2376/**
2377 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2378 *
2379 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2380 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2381 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2382 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2383 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2384 *
2385 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2386 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2387 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2388 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2389 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2390 *	algorithm.
2391 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2392 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2393 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2394 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2395 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2396 *	CCK frames.
2397 *
2398 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2399 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2400 *	the FCS at the end.
2401 *
2402 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2403 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2404 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2405 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2406 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2407 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2408 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2409 *
2410 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2411 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2412 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2413 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2414 *
2415 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2416 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2417 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2418 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2419 *
2420 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2421 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2422 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2423 *
2424 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2425 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2426 *
2427 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2428 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2429 *
2430 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2431 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2432 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2433 *
2434 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2435 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2436 *
2437 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2438 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2439 *
2440 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2441 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2442 *	the stack.
2443 *
2444 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2445 *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2446 *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2447 *
2448 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2449 *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2450 *	dtim_period).
2451 *
2452 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2453 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2454 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2455 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2456 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2457 *	only in that case.
2458 *
2459 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2460 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2461 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2462 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2463 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2464 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2465 *
2466 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2467 *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2468 *	software.
2469 *
2470 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2471 *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2472 *	active interfaces.
2473 *
2474 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2475 *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2476 *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2477 *
2478 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2479 *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2480 *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2481 *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2482 *	supported cipher suites.
2483 *
2484 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2485 *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2486 *	for frames.
2487 *
2488 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2489 *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2490 *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2491 *	control for more details.
2492 *
2493 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2494 *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2495 *
2496 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2497 *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2498 *	is supported.
2499 *
2500 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2501 *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2502 *
2503 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2504 *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2505 *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2506 *
2507 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2508 *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2509 *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2510 *	CSA frame.
2511 *
2512 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2513 *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2514 *
2515 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2516 *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2517 *
2518 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2519 *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2520 *
2521 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2522 *	within A-MPDU.
2523 *
2524 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2525 *	for sent beacons.
2526 *
2527 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2528 *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2529 *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2530 *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2531 *
2532 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2533 *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2534 *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2535 *	timeout.
2536 *
2537 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2538 *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2539 *
2540 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2541 *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2542 *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2543 *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2544 *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2545 *
2546 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2547 *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2548 *
2549 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2550 *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2551 *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2552 *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2553 *
2554 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2555 *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2556 *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2557 *
2558 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2559 *	TDLS links.
2560 *
2561 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2562 *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2563 *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2564 *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2565 *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2566 *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2567 *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2568 *
2569 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2570 *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2571 *
2572 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2573 *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2574 *
2575 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2576 *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2577 *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2578 *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2579 *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2580 *
2581 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2582 *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2583 *	TXQs to start with.
2584 *
2585 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2586 *	length in tx status information
2587 *
2588 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2589 *
2590 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2591 *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2592 *
2593 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2594 *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2595 *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2596 *
2597 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2598 *	offload
2599 *
2600 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2601 *	offload
2602 *
2603 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2604 *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2605 *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2606 *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2607 *	the stack.
2608 *
2609 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2610 *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2611 *
2612 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2613 *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2614 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2615 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2616 */
2617enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2618	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2619	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2620	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2621	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2622	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2623	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2624	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2625	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2626	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2627	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2628	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2629	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2630	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2631	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2632	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2633	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2634	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2635	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2636	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2637	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2638	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2639	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2640	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2641	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2642	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2643	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2644	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2645	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2646	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2647	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2648	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2649	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2650	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2651	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2652	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2653	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2654	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2655	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2656	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2657	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2658	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2659	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2660	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2661	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2662	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2663	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2664	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2665	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2666	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2667	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2668	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2669	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2670	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2671	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
 
 
2672
2673	/* keep last, obviously */
2674	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2675};
2676
2677/**
2678 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2679 *
2680 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2681 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2682 *
2683 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2684 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2685 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2686 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2687 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2688 *
2689 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2690 *
2691 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2692 *	along with this structure.
2693 *
2694 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2695 *
2696 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2697 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2698 *
2699 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2700 *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2701 *
2702 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2703 *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2704 *
2705 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2706 *	that HW supports
2707 *
2708 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2709 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2710 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2711 *
2712 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2713 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2714 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2715 *
2716 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2717 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2718 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2719 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2720 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2721 *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2722 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2723 *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2724 *
2725 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2726 *	can handle.
2727 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2728 *	the hw can report back.
2729 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2730 *
2731 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2732 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2733 *	aggregation.
2734 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2735 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2736 *	it shouldn't be set.
2737 *
2738 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2739 *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2740 *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2741 *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2742 *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2743 *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2744 *
2745 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2746 *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2747 *
2748 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2749 *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2750 *
2751 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2752 *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2753 *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2754 *	adding _BW is supported today.
2755 *
2756 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2757 *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2758 *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2759 *
2760 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2761 *
2762 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2763 *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2764 *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2765 *	device_timestamp.
2766 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2767 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2768 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2769 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2770 *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2771 *
2772 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2773 *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2774 *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2775 *
2776 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2777 *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2778 *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2779 *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2780 *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2781 *	neither enabled.
2782 *
2783 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2784 *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2785 *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2786 *
2787 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2788 *	device.
2789 *
2790 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2791 *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2792 *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2793 *
2794 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2795 *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2796 *
2797 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2798 *
2799 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2800 * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2801 * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2802 *
2803 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2804 */
2805struct ieee80211_hw {
2806	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2807	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2808	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2809	void *priv;
2810	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2811	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2812	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2813	int vif_data_size;
2814	int sta_data_size;
2815	int chanctx_data_size;
2816	int txq_data_size;
2817	u16 queues;
2818	u16 max_listen_interval;
2819	s8 max_signal;
2820	u8 max_rates;
2821	u8 max_report_rates;
2822	u8 max_rate_tries;
2823	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2824	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2825	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2826	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2827	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2828	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2829	struct {
2830		int units_pos;
2831		s16 accuracy;
2832	} radiotap_timestamp;
2833	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2834	u8 uapsd_queues;
2835	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2836	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2837	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2838	u8 weight_multiplier;
2839	u32 max_mtu;
2840	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2841	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2842};
2843
2844static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2845				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2846{
2847	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2848}
2849#define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2850
2851static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2852				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2853{
2854	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2855}
2856#define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2857
2858/**
2859 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2860 *
2861 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2862 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2863 */
2864struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2865	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2866
2867	/* Keep last */
2868	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2869};
2870
2871/**
2872 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2873 *
2874 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2875 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2876 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2877 * @status: channel-switch response status
2878 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2879 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2880 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2881 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2882 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2883 */
2884struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2885	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2886	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2887	u8 action_code;
2888	u32 status;
2889	u32 timestamp;
2890	u16 switch_time;
2891	u16 switch_timeout;
2892	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2893	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2894};
2895
2896/**
2897 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2898 *
2899 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2900 *
2901 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2902 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2903 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2904 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2905 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2906 *
2907 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2908 */
2909struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2910
2911/**
2912 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2913 *
2914 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2915 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2916 */
2917static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2918{
2919	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2920}
2921
2922/**
2923 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2924 *
2925 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2926 * @addr: the address to set
2927 */
2928static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2929{
2930	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2931}
2932
2933static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2934ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2935		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2936{
2937	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2938		return NULL;
2939	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2940}
2941
2942static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2943ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2944			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2945{
2946	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2947		return NULL;
2948	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2949}
2950
2951static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2952ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2953			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2954{
2955	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2956		return NULL;
2957	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2958}
2959
2960/**
2961 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
2962 * @hw: the hardware
2963 * @skb: the skb
2964 *
2965 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
2966 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
2967 */
2968void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2969
2970/**
2971 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
2972 *
2973 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
2974 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
2975 *
2976 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
2977 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
2978 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
2979 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
2980 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
2981 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
2982 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
2983 *
2984 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
2985 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
2986 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
2987 *
2988 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
2989 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
2990 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
2991 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
2992 *
2993 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
2994 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
2995 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
2996 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
2997 *
2998 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
2999 *
3000 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3001 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3002 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3003 * based on the receive flags.
3004 *
3005 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3006 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3007 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3008 * keys.
3009 *
3010 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3011 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3012 * handler.
3013 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3014 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3015 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3016 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3017 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3018 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3019 *
3020 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3021 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3022 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3023 *
3024 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3025 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3026 * requirements:
3027 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3028      once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3029   2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3030      at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3031   3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3032      encrypted with the new key when also needing
3033      @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3034   4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3035   Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3036 */
3037
3038/**
3039 * DOC: Powersave support
3040 *
3041 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3042 *
3043 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3044 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3045 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3046 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3047 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3048 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3049 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3050 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3051 *
3052 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3053 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3054 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3055 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3056 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3057 *
3058 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3059 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3060 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3061 *
3062 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3063 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3064 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3065 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3066 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3067 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3068 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3069 *
3070 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3071 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3072 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3073 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3074 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3075 * periods.
3076 *
3077 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3078 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3079 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3080 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3081 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3082 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3083 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3084 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3085 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3086 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3087 *
3088 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3089 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3090 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3091 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3092 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3093 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3094 *
3095 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3096 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3097 */
3098
3099/**
3100 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3101 *
3102 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3103 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3104 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3105 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3106 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3107 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3108 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3109 *
3110 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3111 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3112 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3113 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3114 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3115 *
3116 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3117 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3118 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3119 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3120 *
3121 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3122 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3123 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3124 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3125 *
3126 *  - a list of information element IDs
3127 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3128 *
3129 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3130 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3131 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3132 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3133 * vendor information elements.
3134 *
3135 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3136 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3137 *
3138 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3139 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3140 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3141 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3142 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3143 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3144 *
3145 *
3146 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3147 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3148 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3149 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3150 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3151 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3152 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3153 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3154 *
3155 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3156 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3157 * signal strength threshold checking.
3158 */
3159
3160/**
3161 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3162 *
3163 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3164 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3165 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3166 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3167 *
3168 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3169 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3170 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3171 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3172 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3173 * hardware flags.
3174 *
3175 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3176 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3177 * turned off otherwise.
3178 *
3179 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3180 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3181 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3182 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3183 */
3184
3185/**
3186 * DOC: Frame filtering
3187 *
3188 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3189 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3190 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3191 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3192 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3193 *
3194 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3195 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3196 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3197 *
3198 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3199 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3200 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3201 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3202 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3203 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3204 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3205 *
3206 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3207 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3208 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3209 * or dropped.
3210 *
3211 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3212 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3213 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3214 * the flag, but not clear it.
3215 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3216 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3217 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3218 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3219 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3220 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3221 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3222 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3223 */
3224
3225/**
3226 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3227 *
3228 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3229 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3230 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3231 *
3232 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3233 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3234 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3235 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3236 * the driver code.
3237 *
3238 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3239 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3240 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3241 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3242 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3243 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3244 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3245 *
3246 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3247 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3248 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3249 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3250 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3251 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3252 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3253 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3254 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3255 * @sta_notify callback.
3256 *
3257 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3258 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3259 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3260 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3261 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3262 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3263 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3264 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3265 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3266 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3267 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3268 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3269 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3270 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3271 *
3272 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3273 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3274 *
3275 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3276 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3277 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3278 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3279 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3280 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3281 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3282 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3283 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3284 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3285 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3286 *
3287 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3288 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3289 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3290 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3291 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3292 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3293 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3294 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3295 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3296 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3297 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3298 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3299 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3300 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3301 *
3302 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3303 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3304 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3305 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3306 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3307 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3308 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3309 *
3310 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3311 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3312 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3313 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3314 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3315 *
3316 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3317 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3318 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3319 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3320 */
3321
3322/**
3323 * DOC: HW queue control
3324 *
3325 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3326 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3327 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3328 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3329 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3330 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3331 *
3332 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3333 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3334 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3335 *
3336 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3337 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3338 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3339 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3340 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3341 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3342 * the hardware queue.
3343 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3344 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3345 *
3346 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3347 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3348 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3349 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3350 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3351 *
3352 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3353 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3354 * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3355 * off-channel queue:         9
3356 *
3357 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3358 *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3359 *
3360 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3361 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3362 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3363 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3364 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3365 *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3366 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3367 *
3368 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3369 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3370 *
3371 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3372 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3373 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3374 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3375 */
3376
3377/**
3378 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3379 *
3380 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3381 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3382 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3383 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3384 *
3385 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3386 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3387 *	multicast address.
3388 *
3389 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3390 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3391 *
3392 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3393 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3394 *
3395 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3396 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3397 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3398 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3399 *	honour this flag if possible.
3400 *
3401 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3402 *	station
3403 *
3404 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3405 *
3406 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3407 *
3408 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3409 *
3410 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3411 */
3412enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3413	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3414	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3415	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3416	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3417	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3418	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3419	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3420	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3421	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3422};
3423
3424/**
3425 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3426 *
3427 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3428 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3429 *
3430 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3431 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3432 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3433 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3434 *
3435 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3436 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3437 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3438 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3439 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3440 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3441 *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3442 *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3443 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3444 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3445 *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3446 *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3447 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3448 *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3449 *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3450 *	session is gone and removes the station.
3451 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3452 *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3453 *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3454 *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3455 */
3456enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3457	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3458	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3459	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3460	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3461	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3462	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3463	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3464};
3465
3466#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3467#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3468
3469/**
3470 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3471 *
3472 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3473 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3474 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3475 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3476 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3477 *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3478 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3479 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3480 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3481 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3482 *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3483 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3484 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3485 */
3486struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3487	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3488	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3489	u16 tid;
3490	u16 ssn;
3491	u16 buf_size;
3492	bool amsdu;
3493	u16 timeout;
3494};
3495
3496/**
3497 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3498 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3499 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3500 *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3501 */
3502enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3503	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3504	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3505};
3506
3507/**
3508 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3509 *
3510 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3511 *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3512 *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3513 *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3514 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3515 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3516 *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3517 *	the peer.
3518 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3519 *	by the peer
3520 */
3521enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3522	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3523	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3524	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3525	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3526};
3527
3528/**
3529 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3530 *
3531 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3532 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3533 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3534 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3535 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3536 *
3537 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3538 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3539 *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3540 */
3541enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3542	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3543	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3544};
3545
3546/**
3547 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3548 *
3549 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3550 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3551 *
3552 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3553 *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3554 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3555 *	of wowlan configuration)
3556 */
3557enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3558	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3559	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3560};
3561
3562/**
3563 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3564 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3565 *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3566 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3567 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3568 *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3569 *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
 
 
3570 */
3571struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3572	u16 duration;
3573	u16 subtype;
3574	u8 success:1;
 
3575};
3576
3577/**
3578 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3579 *
3580 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3581 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3582 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3583 *
3584 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3585 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3586 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3587 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3588 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3589 *	Must be atomic.
3590 *
3591 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3592 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3593 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3594 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3595 *	or zero.
3596 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3597 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3598 *	is added.
3599 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3600 *
3601 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3602 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3603 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3604 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3605 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3606 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3607 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3608 *
3609 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3610 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3611 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3612 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3613 *	reconfigured at resume time.
3614 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3615 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3616 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3617 *	must return 1 from this function.
3618 *
3619 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3620 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3621 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3622 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3623 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3624 *
3625 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3626 *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3627 *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3628 *	in suspend().
3629 *
3630 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3631 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3632 *	and @stop must be implemented.
3633 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3634 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3635 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3636 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3637 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3638 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3639 *
3640 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3641 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3642 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3643 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3644 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3645 *
3646 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3647 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3648 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3649 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3650 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3651 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3652 *	MAC address of the device going away.
3653 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3654 *
3655 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3656 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3657 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3658 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3659 *
3660 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3661 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3662 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3663 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3664 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3665 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3666 *	can sleep.
3667 *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3668 *	are not implemented.
3669 *
3670 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3671 *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3672 *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3673 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3674 *	The callback can sleep.
3675 *
3676 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3677 *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3678 *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3679 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3680 *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3681 *	non-MLO connections.
3682 *	The callback can sleep.
3683 *
3684 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3685 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3686 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3687 *
3688 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3689 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3690 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3691 *
3692 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3693 *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3694 *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3695 *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3696 *	which flags are changed.
3697 *	This callback can sleep.
3698 *
3699 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3700 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3701 *
3702 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3703 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3704 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3705 *	is enabled.
3706 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3707 *	The callback can sleep.
3708 *
3709 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3710 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3711 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3712 *	The callback must be atomic.
3713 *
3714 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3715 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3716 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3717 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3718 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3719 *
3720 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3721 *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3722 *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3723 *
3724 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3725 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3726 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3727 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3728 *	that power save is disabled.
3729 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3730 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3731 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3732 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3733 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3734 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3735 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3736 *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3737 *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3738 *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3739 *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3740 *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3741 *	The callback can sleep.
3742 *
3743 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3744 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3745 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3746 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3747 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3748 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3749 *	The callback can sleep.
3750 *
3751 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3752 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3753 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3754 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3755 *
3756 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3757 *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3758 *
3759 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3760 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3761 *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3762 *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3763 *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3764 *
3765 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3766 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3767 *	this notification.
3768 *	The callback can sleep.
3769 *
3770 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3771 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3772 *	The callback can sleep.
3773 *
3774 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3775 *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3776 *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3777 *	The callback must be atomic.
3778 *
3779 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3780 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3781 *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3782 *	should be set as well.
3783 *	The callback can sleep.
3784 *
3785 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3786 *	The callback can sleep.
3787 *
3788 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3789 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3790 *
3791 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3792 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3793 *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3794 *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3795 *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3796 *	This callback can sleep.
3797 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3798 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3799 *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3800 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3801 *	callback can sleep.
3802 *
3803 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3804 *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3805 *	should be within a CPTCFG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3806 *	callback can sleep.
3807 *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3808 *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3809 *
3810 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3811 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3812 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3813 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3814 *
3815 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3816 *	power for the station.
3817 *	This callback can sleep.
3818 *
3819 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3820 *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3821 *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3822 *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3823 *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3824 *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3825 *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3826 *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3827 *	The callback can sleep.
3828 *
3829 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3830 *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3831 *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3832 *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3833 *	in @sta_state.
3834 *	The callback can sleep.
3835 *
3836 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3837 *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3838 *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3839 *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3840 *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3841 *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3842 *	Must be atomic.
3843 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3844 *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3845 *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3846 *
3847 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3848 *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3849 *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3850 *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3851 *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3852 *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3853 *	The callback can sleep.
3854 *
3855 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3856 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3857 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3858 *	The callback can sleep.
3859 *
3860 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3861 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3862 *	required function.
3863 *	The callback can sleep.
3864 *
3865 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3866 *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3867 *	required function.
3868 *	The callback can sleep.
3869 *
3870 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3871 *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3872 *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3873 *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3874 *	The callback can sleep.
3875 *
3876 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3877 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3878 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3879 *	TSF synchronization.
3880 *	The callback can sleep.
3881 *
3882 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3883 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3884 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3885 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3886 *	The callback can sleep.
3887 *
3888 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3889 *
3890 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3891 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3892 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3893 *	The callback can sleep.
3894 *
3895 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3896 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3897 *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3898 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3899 *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3900 *
3901 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3902 *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3903 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3904 *
3905 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3906 *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3907 *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3908 *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3909 *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3910 *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3911 *	The callback can sleep.
3912 *
 
 
 
 
3913 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3914 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3915 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3916 *	completion of the channel switch.
3917 *
3918 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3919 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3920 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3921 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3922 *
3923 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3924 *
3925 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3926 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3927 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3928 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3929 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3930 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3931 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3932 *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3933 *	must be accepted in this case.
3934 *	This callback may sleep.
3935 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3936 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3937 *
3938 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3939 *
3940 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3941 *
3942 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3943 *	queues before entering power save.
3944 *
3945 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3946 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3947 *	The callback can sleep.
3948 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3949 *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3950 *	The callback must be atomic.
3951 *
3952 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3953 *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3954 *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3955 *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3956 *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3957 *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3958 *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3959 *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
3960 *	more-data bit must always be set.
3961 *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
3962 *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
3963 *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
3964 *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
3965 *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3966 *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
3967 *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
3968 *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
3969 *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
3970 *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
3971 *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
3972 *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
3973 *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
3974 *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
3975 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
3976 *	This callback must be atomic.
3977 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
3978 *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
3979 *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
3980 *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
3981 *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
3982 *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
3983 *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3984 *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
3985 *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
3986 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
3987 *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
3988 *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
3989 *	This callback must be atomic.
3990 *
3991 * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
 
 
3992 *
3993 * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
3994 *
3995 * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
3996 *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
 
 
3997 *
3998 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
3999 *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4000 *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4001 *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4002 *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4003 *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4004 *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4005 *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4006 *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4007 *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4008 *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4009 *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4010 *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4011 *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4012 *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4013 *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4014 *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4015 *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4016 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4017 *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4018 *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4019 *
4020 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4021 *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4022 *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4023 *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4024 *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4025 *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4026 *	2 * (DTIM period).
4027 *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4028 *
4029 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4030 *	This callback may sleep.
4031 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4032 *	This callback may sleep.
4033 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4034 *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4035 *	channel context with different settings
4036 *	This callback may sleep.
4037 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4038 *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4039 *	This callback may sleep.
4040 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4041 *	unbound from vif.
4042 *	This callback may sleep.
4043 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4044 *	another, as specified in the list of
4045 *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4046 *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4047 *	This callback may sleep.
4048 *
4049 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4050 *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4051 *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4052 *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4053 *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4054 *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4055 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4056 *
4057 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4058 *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4059 *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4060 *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4061 *	This callback may sleep.
4062 *
4063 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4064 *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4065 *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4066 *
4067 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4068 *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4069 *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4070 *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4071 *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4072 *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4073 *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4074 *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4075 *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4076 *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4077 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4078 *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4079 *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4080 *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4081 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4082 *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4083 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4084 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4085 *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4086 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4087 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4088 *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4089 *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4090 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4091 *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4092 *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4093 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4094 *
4095 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4096 *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4097 *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4098 *
4099 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4100 *	and hardware limits.
4101 *
4102 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4103 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4104 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4105 *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4106 *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4107 *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4108 *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4109 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4110 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4111 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4112 *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4113 *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4114 *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4115 *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4116 *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4117 *	the function call.
4118 *
4119 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4120 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4121 *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4122 *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4123 *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4124 *
4125 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4126 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4127 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4128 *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4129 *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4130 *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4131 *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4132 *	changed parameters.
4133 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4134 *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4135 *	this call.
4136 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4137 *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4138 *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4139 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4140 *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4141 *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4142 *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4143 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4144 *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4145 *
4146 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4147 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4148 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4149 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4150 *	This callback may sleep.
4151 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4152 *	This callback may sleep.
4153 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4154 *	4-address mode
4155 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4156 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4157 *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4158 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4159 *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4160 *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4161 *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4162 *	twt structure.
4163 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4164 *	from the peer.
4165 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4166 *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4167 *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4168 *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4169 *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4170 *	radar channel.
4171 *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4172 *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4173 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4174 *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
 
 
4175 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4176 *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4177 *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4178 *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4179 *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4180 *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4181 *	This callback can sleep.
4182 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4183 *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4184 *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4185 *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4186 *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4187 */
4188struct ieee80211_ops {
4189	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4190		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4191		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4192	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4193	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4194#ifdef CONFIG_PM
4195	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4196	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4197	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4198#endif
4199	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4200			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4201	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4202				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4203				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4204	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4205				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4206	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4207	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4208				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4209				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4210				 u64 changed);
4211	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4212				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4213				u64 changed);
4214	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4215				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4216				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4217				  u64 changed);
4218
4219	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4220			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4221	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4222			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4223
4224	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4225				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4226	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4227				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4228				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4229				 u64 multicast);
4230	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4231				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4232				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4233				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4234	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4235		       bool set);
4236	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4237		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4238		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4239	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4240				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4241				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4242				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4243				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4244	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4245			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4246			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4247	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4248					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4249	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4250		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4251	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4252			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4253	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4254				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4255				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4256				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4257	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4258			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4259	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4260			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4261			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4262	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4263				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4264	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4265			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4266	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4267			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4268			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4269	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4270	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4271	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4272		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4273	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4274			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4275#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
 
 
 
 
 
 
4276	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4277				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4278				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4279				struct dentry *dir);
4280	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4281				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4282				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4283				     struct dentry *dir);
4284#endif
4285	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4286			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4287	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4288			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4289			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4290	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4291			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4292			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4293			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4294	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4295				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4296				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4297	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4298			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4299			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4300			      u32 changed);
4301	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4302				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4303				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4304	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4305			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4306			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4307			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4308	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4309		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4310		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4311		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4312	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4313	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4314			u64 tsf);
4315	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4316			   s64 offset);
4317	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4318	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4319
4320	/**
4321	 * @ampdu_action:
4322	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4323	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4324	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4325	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4326	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4327	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4328	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4329	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4330	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4331	 *
4332	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4333	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4334	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4335	 *
4336	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4337	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4338	 *
4339	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4340	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4341	 * - ``TX:        81``
4342	 *
4343	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4344	 *
4345	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4346	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4347	 * if the session can start immediately.
4348	 *
4349	 * The callback can sleep.
4350	 */
4351	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4352			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4353			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4354	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4355		struct survey_info *survey);
4356	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4357	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4358#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4359	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4360			    void *data, int len);
4361	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4362			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4363			     void *data, int len);
4364#endif
4365	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4366		      u32 queues, bool drop);
 
 
4367	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4368			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4369			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4370	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4371	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4372
4373	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4374				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4375				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4376				 int duration,
4377				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4378	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4379					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4380	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4381	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4382			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4383	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4384	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4385				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4386	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4387			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4388			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4389
4390	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4391				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4392				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4393				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4394				      bool more_data);
4395	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4396					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4397					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4398					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4399					bool more_data);
4400
4401	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4402				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4403	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4404				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4405				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4406	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4407				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4408				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4409
4410	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4411				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4412				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4413	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4414				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4415				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4416
4417	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4418					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
4419
4420	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4421			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4422	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4423			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4424	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4425			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4426			       u32 changed);
4427	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4428				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4429				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4430				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4431	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4432				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4433				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4434				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4435	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4436				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4437				  int n_vifs,
4438				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4439
4440	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4441				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4442
4443#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4444	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4445				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4446				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4447#endif
4448	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4449				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4450				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4451	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4452				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4453				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4454
4455	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4456				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
4457	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4458				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
4459	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4460					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4461					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4462
4463	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4464	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4465	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4466				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4467	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4468			   int *dbm);
4469
4470	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4471				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4472				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4473				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4474				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4475	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4476					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4477					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4478	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4479					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4480					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4481
4482	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4483			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4484	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4485
4486	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4488			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4489	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4490			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4491	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4492			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4493			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4494	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4495			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4496			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4497	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4499			    u8 instance_id);
4500	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4501				       struct sk_buff *head,
4502				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4503	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4504				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4505				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4506	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4507			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4508	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4509			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4510	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4512			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4513			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4514	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4515				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4516				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4517	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4518				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4519	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4520			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4521	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4522			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4523	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4524				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4525				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4526	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4527			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4528			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4529	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4530				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4531	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4532				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4533	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4534				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4535				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4536				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4537				     struct net_device_path *path);
 
 
 
4538	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4539				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4540				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4541				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4542	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4543				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4544				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4545				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4546};
4547
4548/**
4549 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4550 *
4551 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4552 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4553 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4554 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4555 * @priv_data_len.
4556 *
4557 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4558 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4559 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4560 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4561 *
4562 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4563 */
4564struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4565					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4566					   const char *requested_name);
4567
4568/**
4569 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4570 *
4571 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4572 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4573 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4574 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4575 * @priv_data_len.
4576 *
4577 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4578 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4579 *
4580 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4581 */
4582static inline
4583struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4584					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4585{
4586	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4587}
4588
4589/**
4590 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4591 *
4592 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4593 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4594 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4595 *
4596 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4597 *
4598 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4599 */
4600int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4601
4602/**
4603 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4604 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4605 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4606 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4607 */
4608struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4609	int throughput;
4610	int blink_time;
4611};
4612
4613/**
4614 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4615 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4616 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4617 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4618 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4619 */
4620enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4621	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4622	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4623	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4624};
4625
4626#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4627const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4628const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4629const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4630const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4631const char *
4632__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4633				   unsigned int flags,
4634				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4635				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4636#endif
4637/**
4638 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4639 *
4640 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4641 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4642 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4643 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4644 *
4645 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4646 *
4647 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4648 */
4649static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4650{
4651#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4652	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4653#else
4654	return NULL;
4655#endif
4656}
4657
4658/**
4659 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4660 *
4661 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4662 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4663 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4664 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4665 *
4666 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4667 *
4668 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4669 */
4670static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4671{
4672#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4673	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4674#else
4675	return NULL;
4676#endif
4677}
4678
4679/**
4680 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4681 *
4682 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4683 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4684 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4685 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4686 *
4687 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4688 *
4689 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4690 */
4691static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4692{
4693#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4694	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4695#else
4696	return NULL;
4697#endif
4698}
4699
4700/**
4701 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4702 *
4703 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4704 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4705 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4706 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4707 *
4708 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4709 *
4710 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4711 */
4712static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4713{
4714#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4715	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4716#else
4717	return NULL;
4718#endif
4719}
4720
4721/**
4722 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4723 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4724 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4725 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4726 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4727 *
4728 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4729 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4730 *
4731 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4732 */
4733static inline const char *
4734ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4735				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4736				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4737{
4738#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4739	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4740						  blink_table_len);
4741#else
4742	return NULL;
4743#endif
4744}
4745
4746/**
4747 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4748 *
4749 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4750 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4751 *
4752 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4753 */
4754void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4755
4756/**
4757 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4758 *
4759 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4760 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4761 * before calling this function.
4762 *
4763 * @hw: the hardware to free
4764 */
4765void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4766
4767/**
4768 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4769 *
4770 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4771 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4772 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4773 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4774 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4775 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4776 *
4777 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4778 */
4779void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4780
4781/**
4782 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4783 *
4784 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4785 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4786 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4787 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4788 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4789 *
4790 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4791 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4792 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4793 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4794 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4795 *
4796 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4797 *
4798 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4799 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4800 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4801 * @list: the destination list
4802 */
4803void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4804		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4805
4806/**
4807 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4808 *
4809 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4810 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4811 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4812 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4813 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4814 *
4815 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4816 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4817 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4818 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4819 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4820 *
4821 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4822 *
4823 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4824 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4825 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4826 * @napi: the NAPI context
4827 */
4828void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4829		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4830
4831/**
4832 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4833 *
4834 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4835 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4836 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4837 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4838 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4839 *
4840 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4841 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4842 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4843 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4844 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4845 *
4846 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4847 *
4848 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4849 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4850 */
4851static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4852{
4853	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4854}
4855
4856/**
4857 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4858 *
4859 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4860 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4861 *
4862 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4863 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4864 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4865 *
4866 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4867 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4868 */
4869void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4870
4871/**
4872 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4873 *
4874 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4875 * (internally disables bottom halves).
4876 *
4877 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4878 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4879 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4880 *
4881 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4882 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4883 */
4884static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4885				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4886{
4887	local_bh_disable();
4888	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4889	local_bh_enable();
4890}
4891
4892/**
4893 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4894 *
4895 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4896 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4897 * entering/leaving PS mode.
4898 *
4899 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4900 *
4901 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4902 * each other.
4903 *
4904 * @sta: currently connected sta
4905 * @start: start or stop PS
4906 *
4907 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4908 */
4909int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4910
4911/**
4912 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4913 *                                  (in process context)
4914 *
4915 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4916 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4917 * applies.
4918 *
4919 * @sta: currently connected sta
4920 * @start: start or stop PS
4921 *
4922 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4923 */
4924static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4925						  bool start)
4926{
4927	int ret;
4928
4929	local_bh_disable();
4930	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4931	local_bh_enable();
4932
4933	return ret;
4934}
4935
4936/**
4937 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4938 * @sta: currently connected station
4939 *
4940 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4941 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4942 * connected station was received.
4943 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4944 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4945 * be serialized.
4946 */
4947void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4948
4949/**
4950 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4951 * @sta: currently connected station
4952 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4953 *
4954 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4955 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4956 * from a connected station was received.
4957 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4958 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4959 * serialized.
4960 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
4961 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
4962 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
4963 * checks.
4964 */
4965void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
4966
4967/*
4968 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
4969 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
4970 */
4971#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
4972
4973/**
4974 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
4975 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
4976 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
4977 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
4978 *
4979 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
4980 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
4981 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
4982 *
4983 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
4984 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
4985 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
4986 * call! Beware of the locking!)
4987 *
4988 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
4989 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
4990 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
4991 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
4992 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
4993 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
4994 *
4995 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
4996 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
4997 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
4998 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
4999 * use this API.
5000 */
5001void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5002				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5003
5004/**
5005 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5006 *
5007 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5008 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5009 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5010 *
5011 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5012 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5013 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5014 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5015 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5016 */
5017void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5018			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5019			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5020			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5021			    int max_rates);
5022
5023/**
5024 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5025 *
5026 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5027 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5028 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5029 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5030 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5031 * slow stations to starve).
5032 *
5033 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5034 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5035 */
5036void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5037					   u32 thr);
5038
5039/**
5040 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5041 *
5042 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5043 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5044 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5045 *
5046 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5047 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5048 * @info: tx status information
5049 */
5050void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5051			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5052			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5053
5054/**
5055 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5056 *
5057 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5058 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5059 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5060 *
5061 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5062 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5063 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5064 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5065 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5066 *
5067 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5068 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5069 */
5070void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5071			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5072
5073/**
5074 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5075 *
5076 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5077 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5078 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5079 *
5080 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5081 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5082 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5083 *
5084 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5085 * @status: tx status information
5086 */
5087void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5088			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5089
5090/**
5091 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5092 *
5093 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5094 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5095 * specific skbs.
5096 *
5097 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5098 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5099 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5100 *
5101 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5102 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5103 *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5104 * @info: tx status information
5105 */
5106static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5107					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5108					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5109{
5110	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5111		.sta = sta,
5112		.info = info,
5113	};
5114
5115	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5116}
5117
5118/**
5119 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5120 *
5121 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5122 *
5123 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5124 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5125 * for a single hardware.
5126 *
5127 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5128 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5129 */
5130static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5131					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5132{
5133	local_bh_disable();
5134	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5135	local_bh_enable();
5136}
5137
5138/**
5139 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5140 *
5141 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5142 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5143 *
5144 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5145 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5146 *
5147 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5148 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5149 */
5150void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5151				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5152
5153/**
5154 * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format
5155 *
5156 * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit
5157 * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which
5158 * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap
5159 * 802.11 frames.
5160 *
5161 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5162 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all
5163 * calls in the same tx status family.
5164 *
5165 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5166 * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted
5167 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5168 */
5169void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5170			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5171			       struct sk_buff *skb);
5172
5173/**
5174 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5175 *
5176 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5177 * connected STA.
5178 *
5179 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5180 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5181 */
5182void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5183
5184#define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5185
5186/**
5187 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5188 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5189 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5190 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5191 *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5192 *	should be ignored.
5193 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5194 */
5195struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5196	u16 tim_offset;
5197	u16 tim_length;
5198
5199	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5200	u16 mbssid_off;
5201};
5202
5203/**
5204 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5205 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5206 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5207 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5208 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5209 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
 
5210 *
5211 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5212 * obtain the beacon template.
5213 *
5214 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5215 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5216 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5217 * applicable, the CSA count.
5218 *
5219 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5220 *
5221 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5222 */
5223struct sk_buff *
5224ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5225			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5226			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5227			      unsigned int link_id);
5228
5229/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5230 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5231 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5232 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5233 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5234 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5235 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5236 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5237 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5238 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
 
5239 *
5240 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5241 * obtain the beacon frame.
5242 *
5243 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5244 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5245 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5246 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5247 *
5248 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5249 *
5250 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5251 */
5252struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5253					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5254					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5255					 unsigned int link_id);
5256
5257/**
5258 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5259 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5260 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5261 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
 
5262 *
5263 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5264 *
5265 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5266 */
5267static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5268						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5269						   unsigned int link_id)
5270{
5271	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5272}
5273
5274/**
5275 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5276 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
5277 *
5278 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5279 * This function is called implicitly when
5280 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5281 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5282 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5283 *
5284 * Return: new countdown value
5285 */
5286u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
5287
5288/**
5289 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5290 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5291 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5292 *
5293 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5294 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5295 *
5296 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5297 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5298 */
5299void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5300
5301/**
5302 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5303 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
5304 *
5305 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5306 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5307 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5308 */
5309void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5310
5311/**
5312 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5313 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
5314 *
5315 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5316 */
5317bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
5318
5319/**
5320 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5321 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5322 *
5323 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5324 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5325 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5326 */
5327void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5328
5329/**
5330 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5331 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5332 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5333 *
5334 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5335 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5336 *
5337 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5338 *
5339 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5340 */
5341struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5342					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5343
5344/**
5345 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5346 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5347 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5348 *
5349 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5350 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5351 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5352 *
5353 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5354 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5355 *
5356 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5357 */
5358struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5359				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5360
5361/**
5362 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5363 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5364 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5365 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5366 *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5367 *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5368 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5369 *	if at all possible
5370 *
5371 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5372 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5373 * BSSID and address is used.
5374 *
5375 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5376 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5377 *
5378 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5379 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5380 *
5381 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5382 */
5383struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5384				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5385				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5386
5387/**
5388 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5389 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5390 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5391 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5392 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5393 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5394 *
5395 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5396 * hardware.
5397 *
5398 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5399 */
5400struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5401				       const u8 *src_addr,
5402				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5403				       size_t tailroom);
5404
5405/**
5406 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5407 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5408 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5409 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5410 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5411 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5412 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5413 *
5414 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5415 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5416 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5417 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5418 */
5419void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5420		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5421		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5422		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5423
5424/**
5425 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5426 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5427 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5428 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5429 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5430 *
5431 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5432 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5433 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5434 *
5435 * Return: The duration.
5436 */
5437__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5438			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5439			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5440
5441/**
5442 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5443 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5444 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5445 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5446 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5447 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5448 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5449 *
5450 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5451 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5452 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5453 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5454 */
5455void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5456			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5457			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5458			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5459			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5460
5461/**
5462 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5463 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5464 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5465 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5466 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5467 *
5468 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5469 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5470 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5471 *
5472 * Return: The duration.
5473 */
5474__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5475				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5476				    size_t frame_len,
5477				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5478
5479/**
5480 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5481 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5482 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5483 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5484 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5485 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5486 *
5487 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5488 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5489 *
5490 * Return: The duration.
5491 */
5492__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5493					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5494					enum nl80211_band band,
5495					size_t frame_len,
5496					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5497
5498/**
5499 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5500 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5501 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5502 *
5503 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5504 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5505 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5506 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5507 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5508 *
5509 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5510 * frames are available.
5511 *
5512 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5513 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5514 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5515 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5516 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5517 * use common code for all beacons.
5518 */
5519struct sk_buff *
5520ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5521
5522/**
5523 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5524 *
5525 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5526 *
5527 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5528 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5529 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5530 */
5531void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5532			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5533
5534/**
5535 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5536 *
5537 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5538 * from the given packet.
5539 *
5540 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5541 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5542 *	with this P1K
5543 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5544 */
5545static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5546					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5547{
5548	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5549	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5550	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5551
5552	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5553}
5554
5555/**
5556 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5557 *
5558 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5559 * and transmitter address.
5560 *
5561 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5562 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5563 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5564 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5565 */
5566void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5567			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5568
5569/**
5570 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5571 *
5572 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5573 * in the packet.
5574 *
5575 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5576 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5577 *	encrypted with this key
5578 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5579 */
5580void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5581			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5582
5583/**
5584 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5585 *
5586 * @pos: start of crypto header
5587 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5588 * @pn: PN to add
5589 *
5590 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5591 * the packet payload)
5592 *
5593 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5594 * point to the crypto header)
5595 */
5596u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5597
5598/**
5599 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5600 *
5601 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5602 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5603 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5604 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5605 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5606 *
5607 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5608 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5609 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5610 *
5611 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5612 * can be done concurrently.
5613 */
5614void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5615			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5616
5617/**
5618 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5619 *
5620 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5621 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5622 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5623 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5624 * @seq: new sequence data
5625 *
5626 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5627 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5628 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5629 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5630 *
5631 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5632 * can be done concurrently.
5633 */
5634void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5635			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5636
5637/**
5638 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5639 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5640 *
 
 
5641 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5642 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5643 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5644 *
5645 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5646 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5647 */
5648void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5649
5650/**
5651 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5652 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5653 * @keyconf: new key data
 
5654 *
5655 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5656 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5657 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5658 *
5659 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5660 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5661 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5662 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5663 *
5664 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5665 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5666 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5667 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5668 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5669 * of the reconfiguration.
5670 *
5671 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5672 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5673 *
5674 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5675 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5676 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5677 * the key that's being replaced.
5678 */
5679struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5680ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5681			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
 
5682
5683/**
5684 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5685 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5686 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5687 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5688 * @gfp: allocation flags
5689 */
5690void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5691				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5692
5693/**
5694 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5695 *
5696 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5697 * at the same time.
5698 *
5699 * @keyconf: the key in question
5700 */
5701void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5702
5703/**
5704 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5705 *
5706 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5707 * at the same time.
5708 *
5709 * @keyconf: the key in question
5710 */
5711void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5712
5713/**
5714 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5715 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5716 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5717 *
5718 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5719 */
5720void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5721
5722/**
5723 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5724 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5725 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5726 *
5727 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5728 */
5729void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5730
5731/**
5732 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5733 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5734 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5735 *
5736 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5737 *
5738 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5739 */
5740
5741int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5742
5743/**
5744 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5745 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5746 *
5747 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5748 */
5749void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5750
5751/**
5752 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5753 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5754 *
5755 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5756 */
5757void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5758
5759/**
5760 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5761 *
5762 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5763 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5764 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5765 * any context, including hardirq context.
5766 *
5767 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5768 * @info: information about the completed scan
5769 */
5770void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5771			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5772
5773/**
5774 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5775 *
5776 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5777 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5778 *
5779 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5780 */
5781void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5782
5783/**
5784 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5785 *
5786 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5787 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5788 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5789 * while associating, for instance.
5790 *
5791 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5792 */
5793void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5794
5795/**
5796 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5797 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5798 *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5799 *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5800 *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5801 *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5802 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5803 *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5804 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5805 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5806 *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5807 *	for instance.
5808 */
5809enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5810	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5811	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5812	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5813	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5814};
5815
5816/**
5817 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5818 *
5819 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5820 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5821 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5822 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5823 *
5824 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5825 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5826 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5827 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5828 */
5829void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5830				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5831						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5832				  void *data);
5833
5834/**
5835 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5836 *
5837 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5838 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5839 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5840 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5841 * be used.
5842 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5843 *
5844 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5845 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5846 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5847 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5848 */
5849static inline void
5850ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5851				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5852						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5853				    void *data)
5854{
5855	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5856				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5857				     iterator, data);
5858}
5859
5860/**
5861 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5862 *
5863 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5864 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5865 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5866 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5867 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5868 *
5869 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5870 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5871 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5872 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5873 */
5874void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5875						u32 iter_flags,
5876						void (*iterator)(void *data,
5877						    u8 *mac,
5878						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5879						void *data);
5880
5881/**
5882 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
5883 *
5884 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5885 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5886 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
5887 * The driver must not call this with a lock held that it can also take in
5888 * response to callbacks from mac80211, and it must not call this within
5889 * callbacks made by mac80211 - both would result in deadlocks.
5890 *
5891 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5892 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5893 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5894 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5895 */
5896void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5897					     u32 iter_flags,
5898					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
5899						u8 *mac,
5900						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5901					     void *data);
5902
5903/**
5904 * ieee80211_iterate_stations - iterate stations
5905 *
5906 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5907 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5908 * function for them.
5909 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5910 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic can be used.
5911 *
5912 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5913 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5914 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5915 */
5916void ieee80211_iterate_stations(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5917				void (*iterator)(void *data,
5918						 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5919				void *data);
5920
5921/**
5922 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5923 *
5924 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5925 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5926 * function for them.
5927 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5928 *
5929 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5930 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5931 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5932 */
5933void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5934				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
5935						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5936				       void *data);
5937/**
5938 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5939 *
5940 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5941 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5942 *
5943 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5944 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5945 */
5946void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5947
5948/**
5949 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5950 *
5951 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5952 * workqueue.
5953 *
5954 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5955 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5956 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5957 */
5958void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5959				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
5960				  unsigned long delay);
5961
5962/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5963 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5964 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5965 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5966 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5967 *
5968 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5969 *
5970 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5971 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5972 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5973 */
5974int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5975				  u16 timeout);
5976
5977/**
5978 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5979 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5980 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5981 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5982 *
5983 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5984 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
5985 * from any context.
5986 */
5987void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5988				      u16 tid);
5989
5990/**
5991 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
5992 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
5993 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
5994 *
5995 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
5996 *
5997 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5998 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5999 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6000 */
6001int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6002
6003/**
6004 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6005 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6006 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6007 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6008 *
6009 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6010 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6011 * can be called from any context.
6012 */
6013void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6014				     u16 tid);
6015
6016/**
6017 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6018 *
6019 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6020 * @addr: station's address
6021 *
6022 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6023 *
6024 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6025 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6026 */
6027struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6028					 const u8 *addr);
6029
6030/**
6031 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6032 *
6033 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6034 * @addr: remote station's address
6035 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6036 *
6037 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6038 *
6039 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6040 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6041 *
6042 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6043 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6044 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6045 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6046 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6047 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6048 *      is not reliable.
6049 *
6050 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6051 */
6052struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6053					       const u8 *addr,
6054					       const u8 *localaddr);
6055
6056/**
6057 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6058 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6059 * @addr: remote station's link address
6060 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6061 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6062 *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6063 *
6064 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6065 */
6066struct ieee80211_sta *
6067ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6068				 const u8 *addr,
6069				 const u8 *localaddr,
6070				 unsigned int *link_id);
6071
6072/**
6073 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6074 * @hw: the hardware
6075 * @pubsta: the station
6076 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6077 *
6078 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6079 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6080 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6081 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6082 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6083 *
6084 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6085 * manner.
6086 *
6087 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6088 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6089 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6090 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6091 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6092 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6093 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6094 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6095 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6096 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6097 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6098 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6099 * woke up while blocked or not.
6100 */
6101void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6102			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6103
6104/**
6105 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6106 * @pubsta: the station
6107 *
6108 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6109 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6110 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6111 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6112 *
6113 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6114 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6115 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6116 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6117 *
6118 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6119 *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6120 *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6121 *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6122 */
6123void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6124
6125/**
6126 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6127 * @pubsta: the station
6128 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6129 *
6130 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6131 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6132 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6133 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6134 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6135 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6136 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6137 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6138 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6139 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6140 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6141 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6142 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6143 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6144 */
6145void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6146
6147/**
6148 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6149 * @pubsta: the station
6150 *
6151 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6152 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6153 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6154 *
6155 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6156 * there is no need to call this function.
6157 */
6158void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6159
6160/**
6161 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6162 *
6163 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6164 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6165 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6166 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6167 *
6168 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6169 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6170 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6171 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6172 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6173 * attempts.
6174 *
6175 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6176 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6177 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6178 * them to 0.
6179 *
6180 * @pubsta: the station
6181 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6182 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6183 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6184 */
6185void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6186				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6187
6188/**
6189 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6190 *
6191 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6192 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6193 *
6194 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6195 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6196 */
6197bool
6198ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6199
6200/**
6201 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6202 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6203 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6204 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6205 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6206 *
 
 
6207 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6208 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6209 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6210 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6211 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6212 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6213 *
6214 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6215 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6216 * set_key callback.
6217 */
6218void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6219			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6220			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6221				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6222				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6223				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6224				      void *data),
6225			 void *iter_data);
6226
6227/**
6228 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6229 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6230 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6231 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6232 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6233 *
6234 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6235 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6236 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6237 * in removal process will be skipped.
6238 *
6239 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6240 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6241 */
6242void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6243			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6244			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6245					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6246					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6247					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6248					  void *data),
6249			     void *iter_data);
6250
6251/**
6252 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6253 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6254 * @iter: iterator function
6255 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6256 *
6257 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6258 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6259 * places while calling into the driver.
6260 *
6261 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6262 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6263 * removed.
6264 *
6265 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6266 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6267 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6268 * or not.
6269 */
6270void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6271	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6272	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6273		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6274		     void *data),
6275	void *iter_data);
6276
6277/**
6278 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6279 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6280 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6281 *
6282 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6283 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6284 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6285 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6286 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6287 * %NULL.
6288 *
6289 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6290 */
6291struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6292					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6293
6294/**
6295 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6296 *
6297 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6298 *
6299 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6300 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6301 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6302 */
6303void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6304
6305/**
6306 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6307 *
6308 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6309 *
6310 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6311 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6312 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6313 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6314 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6315 *
6316 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6317 * without connection recovery attempts.
6318 */
6319void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6320
6321/**
6322 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6323 *
6324 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6325 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6326 *
6327 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6328 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6329 */
6330void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6331
6332/**
6333 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6334 *
6335 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6336 *
6337 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6338 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6339 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6340 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6341 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6342 *
6343 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6344 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6345 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6346 * disconnect normally later.
6347 *
6348 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6349 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6350 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6351 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6352 */
6353void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6354
6355/**
6356 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6357 * hardware restart
6358 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6359 *
6360 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6361 * hardware restart.
6362 */
6363void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6364
6365/**
6366 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6367 *	rssi threshold triggered
6368 *
6369 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6370 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6371 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6372 * @gfp: context flags
6373 *
6374 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6375 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6376 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6377 */
6378void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6379			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6380			       s32 rssi_level,
6381			       gfp_t gfp);
6382
6383/**
6384 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6385 *
6386 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6387 * @gfp: context flags
6388 */
6389void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6390
6391/**
6392 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6393 *
6394 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6395 */
6396void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6397
6398/**
6399 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6400 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6401 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
 
 
6402 *
6403 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6404 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6405 */
6406void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
 
6407
6408/**
6409 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6410 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6411 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6412 *
6413 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6414 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6415 * a deauth frame in this case.
6416 */
6417void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6418					 bool block_tx);
6419
6420/**
6421 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6422 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6423 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6424 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6425 *
6426 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6427 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6428 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6429 */
6430void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6431			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6432
6433/**
6434 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6435 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6436 */
6437void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6438
6439/**
6440 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6441 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6442 */
6443void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6444
6445/**
6446 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6447 *
6448 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6449 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6450 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6451 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6452 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6453 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6454 *
6455 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6456 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6457 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6458 */
6459void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6460				  const u8 *addr);
6461
6462/**
6463 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6464 * @pubsta: station struct
6465 * @tid: the session's TID
6466 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6467 *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6468 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6469 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6470 *
6471 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6472 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6473 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6474 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
 
6475 */
6476void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6477					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6478					  u16 received_mpdus);
6479
6480/**
6481 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6482 *
6483 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6484 * buffer.
6485 *
6486 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6487 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6488 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6489 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6490 */
6491void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6492
6493/**
6494 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6495 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6496 * @addr: station mac address
6497 * @tid: the rx tid
6498 */
6499void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6500				 unsigned int tid);
6501
6502/**
6503 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6504 *
6505 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6506 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6507 * reordering.
6508 *
6509 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6510 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6511 *
6512 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6513 * @addr: station mac address
6514 * @tid: the rx tid
6515 */
6516static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6517						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6518{
6519	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6520		return;
6521	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6522}
6523
6524/**
6525 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6526 *
6527 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6528 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6529 * reordering.
6530 *
6531 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6532 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6533 *
6534 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6535 * @addr: station mac address
6536 * @tid: the rx tid
6537 */
6538static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6539						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6540{
6541	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6542		return;
6543	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6544}
6545
6546/**
6547 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6548 *
6549 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6550 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6551 *
6552 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6553 *
6554 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6555 * @addr: station mac address
6556 * @tid: the rx tid
6557 */
6558void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6559				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6560
6561/* Rate control API */
6562
6563/**
6564 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6565 *
6566 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6567 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6568 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6569 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6570 *	to be filled in
6571 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6572 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6573 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6574 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6575 *	RTS threshold
6576 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6577 *	if the selected rate supports it
6578 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6579 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6580 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6581 */
6582struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6583	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6584	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6585	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6586	struct sk_buff *skb;
6587	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6588	bool rts, short_preamble;
6589	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6590	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6591	bool bss;
6592};
6593
6594/**
6595 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6596 */
6597enum rate_control_capabilities {
6598	/**
6599	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6600	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6601	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6602	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6603	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6604	 */
6605	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6606	/**
6607	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6608	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6609	 */
6610	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6611};
6612
6613struct rate_control_ops {
6614	unsigned long capa;
6615	const char *name;
6616	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6617	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6618			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6619	void (*free)(void *priv);
6620
6621	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6622	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6623			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6624			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6625	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6626			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6627			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6628			    u32 changed);
6629	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6630			 void *priv_sta);
6631
6632	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6633			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6634			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6635	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6636			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6637			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6638	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6639			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6640
6641	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6642				struct dentry *dir);
6643
6644	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6645};
6646
6647static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6648				 enum nl80211_band band,
6649				 int index)
6650{
6651	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6652}
6653
6654static inline s8
6655rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6656		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6657{
6658	int i;
6659
6660	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6661		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6662			return i;
6663
6664	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6665	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6666
6667	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6668	return 0;
6669}
6670
6671static inline
6672bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6673			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6674{
6675	unsigned int i;
6676
6677	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6678		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6679			return true;
6680	return false;
6681}
6682
6683/**
6684 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6685 *
6686 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6687 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6688 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6689 * the most recent rate control module decision.
6690 *
6691 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6692 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6693 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6694 */
6695int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6696			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6697			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6698
6699int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6700void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6701
6702static inline bool
6703conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6704{
6705	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6706}
6707
6708static inline bool
6709conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6710{
6711	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6712	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6713}
6714
6715static inline bool
6716conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6717{
6718	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6719	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6720}
6721
6722static inline bool
6723conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6724{
6725	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6726}
6727
6728static inline bool
6729conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6730{
6731	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6732		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6733		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6734}
6735
6736static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6737ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6738{
6739	if (p2p) {
6740		switch (type) {
6741		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6742			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6743		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6744			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6745		default:
6746			break;
6747		}
6748	}
6749	return type;
6750}
6751
6752static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6753ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6754{
6755	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6756}
6757
6758/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6759 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6760 *
6761 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6762 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6763 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6764 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6765 *
6766 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6767 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6768 * matching GroupId management frame.
6769 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6770 */
6771void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6772				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6773
6774void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6775				   int rssi_min_thold,
6776				   int rssi_max_thold);
6777
6778void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6779
6780/**
6781 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6782 *
6783 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6784 *
6785 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6786 *
6787 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6788 * applicable.
6789 */
6790int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6791
6792/**
6793 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6794 * @vif: virtual interface
6795 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6796 * @gfp: allocation flags
6797 *
6798 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6799 */
6800void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6801				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6802				    gfp_t gfp);
6803
6804/**
6805 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6806 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6807 * @vif: virtual interface
6808 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6809 * @band: the band to transmit on
6810 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6811 *
6812 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6813 */
6814bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6815			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6816			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6817
6818/**
6819 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
6820 *				 of injected frames.
6821 *
6822 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
6823 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
6824 * of the skb before calling this function.
6825 *
6826 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6827 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
6828 */
6829bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6830				 struct net_device *dev);
6831
6832/**
6833 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6834 *
6835 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6836 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6837 *
6838 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6839 *
6840 * private:
6841 *
6842 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6843 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6844 */
6845struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6846	u32 next_tsf;
6847	bool has_next_tsf;
6848
6849	u8 absent;
6850
6851	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6852	struct {
6853		u32 start;
6854		u32 duration;
6855		u32 interval;
6856	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6857};
6858
6859/**
6860 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6861 *
6862 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6863 * @data: NoA tracking data
6864 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6865 *
6866 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6867 */
6868int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6869			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6870
6871/**
6872 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6873 *
6874 * @data: NoA tracking data
6875 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6876 */
6877void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6878
6879/**
6880 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6881 * @vif: virtual interface
6882 * @peer: the peer's destination address
6883 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6884 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6885 * @gfp: allocation flags
6886 *
6887 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6888 */
6889void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6890				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6891				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6892
6893/**
6894 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6895 *
6896 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6897 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6898 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6899 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6900 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6901 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6902 *
6903 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6904 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6905 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6906 *
6907 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6908 * @tid: the TID to reserve
6909 *
6910 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6911 */
6912int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6913
6914/**
6915 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6916 *
6917 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6918 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6919 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6920 *
6921 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6922 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6923 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6924 *
6925 * @sta: the station
6926 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6927 */
6928void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6929
6930/**
6931 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6932 *
6933 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6934 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6935 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6936 *
6937 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6938 *
6939 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6940 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6941 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
6942 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6943 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6944 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6945 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6946 *
6947 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6948 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6949 */
6950struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6951				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6952
6953/**
6954 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6955 * (in process context)
6956 *
6957 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6958 * (internally disables bottom halves).
6959 *
6960 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6961 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6962 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6963 */
6964static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6965						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6966{
6967	struct sk_buff *skb;
6968
6969	local_bh_disable();
6970	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6971	local_bh_enable();
6972
6973	return skb;
6974}
6975
6976/**
6977 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
6978 *
6979 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
6980 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
6981 *
6982 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
6983 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
6984 */
6985void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6986				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6987
6988/**
6989 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
6990 *
6991 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6992 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
6993 *
6994 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
6995 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
6996 * driver has finished scheduling it.
6997 */
6998struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6999
7000/**
7001 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7002 *
7003 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7004 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7005 *
7006 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7007 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7008 */
7009void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7010
7011/* (deprecated) */
7012static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7013{
7014}
7015
7016void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7017			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7018
7019/**
7020 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7021 *
7022 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7023 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7024 *
7025 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7026 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7027 *
7028 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7029 * this TXQ internally.
7030 */
7031static inline void
7032ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7033{
7034	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7035}
7036
7037/**
7038 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7039 *
7040 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7041 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7042 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7043 *
7044 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7045 * internally.
7046 */
7047static inline void
7048ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7049		     bool force)
7050{
7051	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7052}
7053
7054/**
7055 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7056 *
7057 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7058 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7059 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7060 * next_txq().
7061 *
7062 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7063 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7064 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7065 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7066 * again.
7067 *
7068 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7069 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7070 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7071 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7072 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7073 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7074 *
7075 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7076 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7077 */
7078bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7079				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7080
7081/**
7082 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7083 *
7084 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7085 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7086 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7087 *
7088 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7089 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7090 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7091 */
7092void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7093			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7094			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7095
7096/**
7097 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7098 *
7099 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7100 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7101 *
7102 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7103 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7104 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7105 * @gfp: allocation flags
7106 */
7107void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7108				   u8 inst_id,
7109				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7110				   gfp_t gfp);
7111
7112/**
7113 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7114 *
7115 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7116 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7117 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7118 *
7119 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7120 * @match: match event information
7121 * @gfp: allocation flags
7122 */
7123void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7124			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7125			      gfp_t gfp);
7126
7127/**
7128 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7129 *
7130 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7131 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7132 *
7133 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7134 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7135 *          information.
7136 * @len: frame length in bytes
7137 */
7138u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7139			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7140			      int len);
7141
7142/**
7143 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7144 *
7145 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7146 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7147 *
7148 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7149 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7150 * @len: frame length in bytes
7151 */
7152u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7153			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7154			      int len);
7155/**
7156 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7157 *
7158 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7159 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7160 * hardware or firmware.
7161 *
7162 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7163 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7164 */
7165bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7166
7167/**
7168 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7169 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7170 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7171 *
7172 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7173 *
7174 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7175 */
7176struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7177						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7178
7179/**
7180 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7181 *	probe response template.
7182 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7183 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7184 *
7185 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7186 *
7187 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7188 */
7189struct sk_buff *
7190ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7191					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7192
7193/**
7194 * ieeee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7195 * collision.
7196 *
7197 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7198 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7199 *	aware of.
7200 * @gfp: allocation flags
7201 */
7202void
7203ieeee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7204				       u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7205
7206/**
7207 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7208 *
7209 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7210 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7211 *
7212 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7213 */
7214static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7215{
7216	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7217	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7218
7219	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7220	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7221}
7222
7223/**
7224 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7225 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7226 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7227 *
 
 
 
7228 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7229 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7230 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7231 *
7232 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7233 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7234 * a sequence of calls like
 
7235 *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7236 *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7237 *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7238 *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7239 *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7240 *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7241 *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7242 *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7243 *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7244 *
7245 * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7246 *	 be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7247 *	 lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7248 */
7249int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7250
7251/**
7252 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7253 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7254 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7255 *
7256 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7257 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7258 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7259 * completed after it returns.
7260 */
7261void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7262				      u16 active_links);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7263
7264#endif /* MAC80211_H */
v6.9.4
   1/* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
   2/*
   3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   4 *
   5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   6 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   7 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   8 * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
  10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2024 Intel Corporation
  11 */
  12
  13#ifndef MAC80211_H
  14#define MAC80211_H
  15
  16#include <linux/bug.h>
  17#include <linux/kernel.h>
  18#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  19#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  20#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  21#include <linux/lockdep.h>
  22#include <net/cfg80211.h>
  23#include <net/codel.h>
  24#include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
  25#include <asm/unaligned.h>
  26
  27/**
  28 * DOC: Introduction
  29 *
  30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  33 * drivers.
  34 */
  35
  36/**
  37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  38 *
  39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  44 * tasklet function.
  45 *
  46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  47 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  48 */
  49
  50/**
  51 * DOC: Warning
  52 *
  53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  55 */
  56
  57/**
  58 * DOC: Frame format
  59 *
  60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  63 * hardware.
  64 *
  65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  66 *
  67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  69 *
  70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
  72 */
  73
  74/**
  75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  76 *
  77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  81 *
  82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  83 * suspend.
  84 *
  85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  86 *
  87 */
  88
  89/**
  90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
  91 *
  92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
  93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
  94 * different stations/interfaces.
  95 *
  96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
  97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
  98 * handler.
  99 *
 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
 103 *
 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
 106 *
 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
 109 * driver op.
 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
 113 *
 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
 118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
 119 *
 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
 124 * .release_buffered_frames().
 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
 128 */
 129
 130/**
 131 * DOC: HW timestamping
 132 *
 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
 135 *
 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
 140 *
 141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
 145 */
 146struct device;
 147
 148/**
 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
 150 *
 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
 153 */
 154enum ieee80211_max_queues {
 155	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
 156	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
 157};
 158
 159#define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
 160
 161/**
 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 167 */
 168enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 169	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 170	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 171	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 172	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 173};
 174
 175/**
 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 177 *
 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 180 *
 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 183 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
 190 */
 191struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 192	u16 txop;
 193	u16 cw_min;
 194	u16 cw_max;
 195	u8 aifs;
 196	bool acm;
 197	bool uapsd;
 198	bool mu_edca;
 199	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
 200};
 201
 202struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 203	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 204	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 205	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 206	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 207};
 208
 209/**
 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
 215 *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
 217 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
 218 *	bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
 219 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
 220 *	was changed.
 221 */
 222enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
 223	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
 224	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
 225	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
 226	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
 227	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
 228	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP		= BIT(5),
 229	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING	= BIT(6),
 230};
 231
 232/**
 233 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
 234 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
 235 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
 236 *	(otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
 237 */
 238struct ieee80211_chan_req {
 239	struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
 240	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
 241};
 242
 243/**
 244 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
 245 *
 246 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
 247 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
 248 *
 249 * @def: the channel definition
 250 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
 251 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
 252 *	for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
 253 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
 254 *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
 255 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
 256 *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
 257 *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
 258 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
 259 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 260 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 261 */
 262struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
 263	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
 264	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
 265	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
 266
 267	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
 268
 269	bool radar_enabled;
 270
 271	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
 272};
 273
 274/**
 275 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
 276 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
 277 *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
 278 *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
 279 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
 280 *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
 281 *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
 282 *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
 283 *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
 284 *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
 285 *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
 286 *      for changes/removal.)
 287 */
 288enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
 289	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
 290	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
 291};
 292
 293/**
 294 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
 295 *
 296 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
 297 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
 298 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
 299 * done.
 300 *
 301 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
 302 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
 303 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
 304 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
 305 */
 306struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
 307	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 308	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
 309	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
 310	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
 311};
 312
 313/**
 314 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 315 *
 316 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
 317 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
 318 *
 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 320 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 324 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 326 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 328 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 329 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 330 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 332 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 333 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 336 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 337 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
 342 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
 343 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
 344 *	changed
 345 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
 346 *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
 347 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
 348 *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
 349 *	context had been assigned.
 350 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
 351 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
 352 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
 353 *	keep alive) changed.
 354 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
 355 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
 356 *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
 357 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
 358 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
 359 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
 360 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
 361 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 362 *	status changed.
 363 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
 364 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: TID to link mapping was changed
 365 */
 366enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 367	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 368	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 369	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 370	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 371	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
 372	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 373	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 374	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 375	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 376	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 377	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 378	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 379	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 380	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 381	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 382	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
 383	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
 384	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
 385	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
 386	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
 387	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
 388	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
 389	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
 390	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
 391	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
 392	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
 393	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
 394	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
 395	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
 396	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
 397	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
 398	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
 399	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
 400	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM		= BIT_ULL(34),
 401
 402	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 403};
 404
 405/*
 406 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 407 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 408 * filtering will be disabled.
 409 */
 410#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 411
 412/**
 413 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
 414 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
 415 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
 416 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
 417 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
 418 *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
 419 *	once each time the timeout triggers.
 420 */
 421enum ieee80211_event_type {
 422	RSSI_EVENT,
 423	MLME_EVENT,
 424	BAR_RX_EVENT,
 425	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
 426};
 427
 428/**
 429 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
 430 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
 431 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
 432 */
 433enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
 434	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 435	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 436};
 437
 438/**
 439 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
 440 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
 441 */
 442struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
 443	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
 444};
 445
 446/**
 447 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 448 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
 449 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
 450 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
 451 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
 452 */
 453enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
 454	AUTH_EVENT,
 455	ASSOC_EVENT,
 456	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
 457	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
 458};
 459
 460/**
 461 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 462 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
 463 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
 464 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
 465 */
 466enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
 467	MLME_SUCCESS,
 468	MLME_DENIED,
 469	MLME_TIMEOUT,
 470};
 471
 472/**
 473 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
 474 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
 475 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
 476 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
 477 */
 478struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
 479	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
 480	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
 481	u16 reason;
 482};
 483
 484/**
 485 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
 486 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
 487 * @tid: the tid
 488 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
 489 */
 490struct ieee80211_ba_event {
 491	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 492	u16 tid;
 493	u16 ssn;
 494};
 495
 496/**
 497 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
 498 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
 499 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
 500 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
 501 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
 502 * @u:union holding the fields above
 503 */
 504struct ieee80211_event {
 505	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
 506	union {
 507		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
 508		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
 509		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
 510	} u;
 511};
 512
 513/**
 514 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
 515 *
 516 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
 517 *
 518 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 519 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 520 */
 521struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
 522	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
 523	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
 524};
 525
 526/**
 527 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
 528 *
 529 * @lci: LCI subelement content
 530 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
 531 * @lci_len: LCI data length
 532 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
 533 */
 534struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
 535	const u8 *lci;
 536	const u8 *civicloc;
 537	size_t lci_len;
 538	size_t civicloc_len;
 539};
 540
 541/**
 542 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
 543 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
 544 *
 545 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 546 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
 547 */
 548struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
 549	u32 min_interval;
 550	u32 max_interval;
 551};
 552
 553/**
 554 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 555 *
 556 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 557 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 558 *
 559 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
 560 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
 561 *	when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
 562 *	necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
 563 *	responses.
 564 * @addr: (link) address used locally
 565 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
 566 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
 567 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
 
 
 568 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
 569 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
 570 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
 571 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 572 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 573 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
 574 *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
 575 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
 576 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
 577 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 578 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
 579 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
 580 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 581 *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
 582 *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
 583 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
 584 *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
 585 *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
 586 *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
 587 *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
 588 *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 589 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
 590 *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
 591 *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 592 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
 593 *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
 594 *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
 595 *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
 596 *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
 597 *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
 598 *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
 599 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 600 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 601 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 602 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 603 *	the current band.
 604 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
 605 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 606 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 607 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 608 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 609 *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
 610 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
 611 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
 612 *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
 613 *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
 614 *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
 615 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 616 *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
 617 *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
 618 *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
 619 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
 620 *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
 621 *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
 622 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
 623 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 624 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 625 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
 626 * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
 627 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
 628 *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
 629 *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
 630 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
 631 *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
 632 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
 633 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
 634 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
 635 *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
 636 *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
 637 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
 638 *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
 639 *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
 640 *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
 641 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
 642 *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
 643 *	station.
 644 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
 645 *	responder functionality.
 646 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
 647 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
 648 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
 649 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
 650 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
 651 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
 652 *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
 653 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
 654 *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
 655 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
 656 *	connected to (STA)
 657 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
 658 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
 659 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
 660 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
 661 *	interval.
 662 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
 663 *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
 664 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
 665 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
 666 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
 667 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
 668 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
 669 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
 
 
 670 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
 671 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
 672 *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
 673 *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
 674 *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
 675 *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
 676 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
 
 
 677 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
 678 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
 679 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
 680 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
 681 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
 682 *	beamformer
 683 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
 684 *	beamformee
 685 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
 686 *	beamformer
 687 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
 688 *	beamformee
 689 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
 690 *	beamformer
 691 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
 692 *	beamformee
 693 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
 694 *	beamformer
 695 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
 696 *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
 697 *	bandwidth
 698 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
 699 *	beamformer
 700 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
 701 *	beamformee
 702 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
 703 *	beamformer
 704 */
 705struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 706	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 707	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
 708
 709	const u8 *bssid;
 710	unsigned int link_id;
 711	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
 712	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
 713	bool uora_exists;
 714	u8 uora_ocw_range;
 715	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
 716	bool he_support;
 717	bool twt_requester;
 718	bool twt_responder;
 719	bool twt_protected;
 720	bool twt_broadcast;
 721	/* erp related data */
 722	bool use_cts_prot;
 723	bool use_short_preamble;
 724	bool use_short_slot;
 725	bool enable_beacon;
 726	u8 dtim_period;
 727	u16 beacon_int;
 728	u16 assoc_capability;
 729	u64 sync_tsf;
 730	u32 sync_device_ts;
 731	u8 sync_dtim_count;
 732	u32 basic_rates;
 733	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
 734	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 735	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 736	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 737	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 738	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
 739	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
 740	struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
 741	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
 742	bool qos;
 743	bool hidden_ssid;
 744	int txpower;
 745	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
 746	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
 747	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
 748	u16 max_idle_period;
 749	bool protected_keep_alive;
 750	bool ftm_responder;
 751	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
 752	/* Multiple BSSID data */
 753	bool nontransmitted;
 754	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
 755	u8 bssid_index;
 756	u8 bssid_indicator;
 757	bool ema_ap;
 758	u8 profile_periodicity;
 759	struct {
 760		u32 params;
 761		u16 nss_set;
 762	} he_oper;
 763	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
 764	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
 765	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
 766	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
 767	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
 768	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
 769	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
 770	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
 771	u8 pwr_reduction;
 772	bool eht_support;
 773
 774	bool csa_active;
 775
 776	bool mu_mimo_owner;
 777	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
 778
 779	bool color_change_active;
 780	u8 color_change_color;
 781
 782	bool ht_ldpc;
 783	bool vht_ldpc;
 784	bool he_ldpc;
 785	bool vht_su_beamformer;
 786	bool vht_su_beamformee;
 787	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
 788	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
 789	bool he_su_beamformer;
 790	bool he_su_beamformee;
 791	bool he_mu_beamformer;
 792	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
 793	bool eht_su_beamformer;
 794	bool eht_su_beamformee;
 795	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
 796};
 797
 798/**
 799 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 800 *
 801 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 802 *
 803 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 804 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 805 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 806 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 807 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 808 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 809 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 810 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 811 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 812 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 813 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 814 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 815 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 816 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 817 *	station
 818 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 819 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 820 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 821 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 822 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 823 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 824 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 825 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 826 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 827 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 828 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 829 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 830 *	hardware queue.
 831 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 832 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 833 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 834 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 835 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 836 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 837 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 838 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 839 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
 840 *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
 841 *	off-channel operation.
 842 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
 843 *	(header conversion)
 844 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 845 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 846 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 847 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 848 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
 849 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
 850 *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
 851 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 852 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 853 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 854 *	queue gets full.
 855 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 856 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 857 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 858 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
 859 *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
 860 *	should kick the MLME state machine.
 861 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 862 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 863 *	status to user space)
 864 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 865 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 866 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 867 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 868 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 869 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 870 *	handled properly by the device.
 871 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 872 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 873 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 874 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
 875 *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
 876 *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
 877 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
 878 *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
 879 *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
 880 *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
 881 *	PS-Poll responses.
 882 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
 883 *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
 884 *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
 885 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
 886 *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
 887 *	monitor injection).
 888 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
 889 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
 890 *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
 891 *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
 892 *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
 893 *
 894 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 895 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 896 */
 897enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
 898	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 899	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 900	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 901	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 902	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 903	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 904	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 905	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 906	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 907	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 908	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 909	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 910	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 911	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
 912	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
 913	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 914	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 915	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
 916	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 917	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 918	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
 919	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 920	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 921	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 922	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 923	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 924	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
 925	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
 926	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
 927	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
 928	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
 929};
 930
 931#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 932
 933#define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
 934
 935/**
 936 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
 937 *
 938 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
 939 *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
 940 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
 941 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
 942 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
 943 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
 944 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
 945 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
 946 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 947 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 948 *	it can be sent out.
 949 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
 950 *	has already been assigned to this frame.
 951 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
 952 *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
 953 *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
 954 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
 955 *	for sequence number assignment
 956 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SCAN_TX: Indicates that this frame is transmitted
 957 *	due to scanning, not in normal operation on the interface.
 958 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
 959 *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
 960 *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
 961 *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
 962 *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
 963 *	it's intended for an MLD.
 964 *
 965 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
 966 */
 967enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
 968	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
 969	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
 970	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
 971	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
 972	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
 973	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
 974	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
 975	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
 976	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
 977	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
 978	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SCAN_TX		= BIT(10),
 979	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
 980};
 981
 982#define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
 983#define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
 984	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
 985			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
 986
 987/**
 988 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
 989 *
 990 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
 991 *
 992 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
 993 */
 994enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
 995	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
 996};
 997
 998/*
 999 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1000 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1001 */
1002#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
1003	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
1004	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
1005	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
1006	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
1007	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
1008	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
1009	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1010
1011/**
1012 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1013 *	Rate Control algorithm.
1014 *
1015 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1016 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1017 *
1018 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1019 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1020 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1021 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1022 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1023 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1024 *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1025 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1026 *	Greenfield mode.
1027 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1028 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1029 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1030 *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1031 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1032 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1033 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1034 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1035 */
1036enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1037	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1038	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1039	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1040
1041	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1042	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1043	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1044	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1045	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1046	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1047	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1048	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1049	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1050};
1051
1052
1053/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1054#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1055
1056/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1057#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1058
1059/* maximum number of rate stages */
1060#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1061
1062/* maximum number of rate table entries */
1063#define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1064
1065/**
1066 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1067 *
1068 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1069 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1070 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1071 *
1072 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1073 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1074 *
1075 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1076 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1077 *
1078 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1079 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1080 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1081 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1082 * information::
1083 *
1084 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1085 *
1086 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1087 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1088 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1089 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1090 * information should then contain::
1091 *
1092 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1093 *
1094 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1095 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1096 */
1097struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1098	s8 idx;
1099	u16 count:5,
1100	    flags:11;
1101} __packed;
1102
1103#define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1104
1105static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1106{
1107	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1108}
1109
1110static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1111					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1112{
1113	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1114	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1115	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1116}
1117
1118static inline u8
1119ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1120{
1121	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1122}
1123
1124static inline u8
1125ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1126{
1127	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1128}
1129
1130/**
1131 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1132 *
1133 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1134 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1135 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1136 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1137 *
1138 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1139 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1140 *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1141 *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1142 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1143 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1144 *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1145 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1146 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1147 * @control: union part for control data
1148 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1149 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1150 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1151 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1152 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1153 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1154 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1155 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1156 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1157 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1158 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1159 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1160 * @pad: padding
1161 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1162 * @status: union part for status data
1163 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1164 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1165 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1166 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1167 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1168 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1169 *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1170 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1171 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1172 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1173 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1174 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
 
 
 
 
 
1175 */
1176struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1177	/* common information */
1178	u32 flags;
1179	u32 band:3,
1180	    status_data_idr:1,
1181	    status_data:13,
1182	    hw_queue:4,
1183	    tx_time_est:10;
1184	/* 1 free bit */
1185
1186	union {
1187		struct {
1188			union {
1189				/* rate control */
1190				struct {
1191					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1192						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1193					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1194					u8 use_rts:1;
1195					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1196					u8 short_preamble:1;
1197					u8 skip_table:1;
1198
1199					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1200					u8 antennas:2;
1201
1202					/* 14 bits free */
1203				};
1204				/* only needed before rate control */
1205				unsigned long jiffies;
1206			};
1207			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1208			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1209			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1210			u32 flags;
1211			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1212		} control;
1213		struct {
1214			u64 cookie;
1215		} ack;
1216		struct {
1217			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1218			s32 ack_signal;
1219			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1220			u8 ampdu_len;
1221			u8 antenna;
1222			u8 pad;
1223			u16 tx_time;
1224			u8 flags;
1225			u8 pad2;
1226			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1227		} status;
1228		struct {
1229			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1230				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1231			u8 pad[4];
1232
1233			void *rate_driver_data[
1234				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1235		};
1236		void *driver_data[
1237			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1238	};
1239};
1240
1241static inline u16
1242ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1243{
1244	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1245	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1246	 */
1247	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1248	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1249}
1250
1251static inline u16
1252ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1253{
1254	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1255}
1256
1257/***
1258 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1259 *
1260 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1261 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1262 *
1263 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1264 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1265 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1266 * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1267 * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1268 */
1269struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1270	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1271	u8 try_count;
1272	u8 tx_power_idx;
1273};
1274
1275/**
1276 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1277 *
1278 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1279 * @info: Basic tx status information
1280 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1281 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1282 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1283 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1284 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1285 *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1286 *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1287 */
1288struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1289	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1290	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1291	struct sk_buff *skb;
1292	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1293	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1294	u8 n_rates;
1295
1296	struct list_head *free_list;
1297};
1298
1299/**
1300 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1301 *
1302 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1303 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1304 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1305 *
1306 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1307 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1308 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1309 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1310 */
1311struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1312	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1313	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1314	const u8 *common_ies;
1315	size_t common_ie_len;
1316};
1317
1318
1319static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1320{
1321	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1322}
1323
1324static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1325{
1326	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1327}
1328
1329/**
1330 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1331 *
1332 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1333 *
1334 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1335 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1336 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1337 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1338 *
1339 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1340 *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1341 *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1342 */
1343static inline void
1344ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1345{
1346	int i;
1347
1348	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1349		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1350	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1351		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1352	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1353	/* clear the rate counts */
1354	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1355		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1356	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1357}
1358
1359
1360/**
1361 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1362 *
1363 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1364 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1365 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1366 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1367 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1368 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1369 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1370 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1371 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1372 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1373 *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1374 *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1375 *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1376 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1377 *	de-duplication by itself.
1378 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1379 *	the frame.
1380 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1381 *	the frame.
1382 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1383 *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1384 *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1385 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1386 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1387 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1388 *	merging.
1389 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1390 *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1391 *	(including FCS) was received.
1392 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1393 *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1394 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1395 *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1396 *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1397 *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1398 *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1399 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1400 *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1401 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1402 *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1403 *	each A-MPDU
1404 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1405 *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1406 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1407 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1408 *	on this subframe
1409 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1410 *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1411 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1412 *	done by the hardware
1413 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1414 *	processing it in any regular way.
1415 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1416 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1417 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1418 *	monitor interfaces.
1419 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1420 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1421 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1422 *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1423 *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1424 *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1425 *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1426 *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1427 *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1428 *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1429 *	interleaved with other frames.
1430 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1431 *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1432 *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1433 *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1434 *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1435 *	in the skb.
1436 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1437 *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1438 *	the first subframe.
1439 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1440 *	be done in the hardware.
1441 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1442 *	frame
1443 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1444 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1445 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1446 *	
1447 *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1448 *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1449 *	 - DATA3_CODING
1450 *	 - DATA5_GI
1451 *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1452 *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1453 *	 - DATA3_STBC
1454 *	
1455 *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1456 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1457 *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1458 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1459 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1460 *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1461 *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1462 *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1463 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1464 *	hardware or driver)
1465 */
1466enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1467	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1468	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1469	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1470	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1471	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1472	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1473	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1474	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1475	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1476	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1477	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1478	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1479	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1480	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1481	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1482	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1483	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1484	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1485	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1486	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1487	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1488	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1489	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1490	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1491	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1492	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1493	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1494	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1495	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1496	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1497	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1498	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1499	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1500};
1501
1502/**
1503 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1504 *
1505 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1506 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1507 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1508 *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1509 *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1510 *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1511 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1512 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1513 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1514 */
1515enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1516	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1517	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1518	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1519	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1520	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1521	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1522};
1523
1524#define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1525
1526enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1527	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1528	RX_ENC_HT,
1529	RX_ENC_VHT,
1530	RX_ENC_HE,
1531	RX_ENC_EHT,
1532};
1533
1534/**
1535 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1536 *
1537 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1538 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1539 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1540 *
1541 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1542 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1543 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1544 *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1545 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1546 *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1547 *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1548 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1549 *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1550 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1551 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1552 *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1553 *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1554 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1555 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1556 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1557 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1558 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1559 *	values were filled.
1560 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1561 *	support dB or unspecified units)
1562 * @antenna: antenna used
1563 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1564 *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1565 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1566 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1567 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1568 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1569 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1570 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1571 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1572 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1573 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1574 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1575 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1576 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1577 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1578 *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1579 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1580 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1581 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1582 *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1583 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1584 *	@link_valid.
1585 */
1586struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1587	u64 mactime;
1588	union {
1589		u64 boottime_ns;
1590		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1591	};
1592	u32 device_timestamp;
1593	u32 ampdu_reference;
1594	u32 flag;
1595	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1596	u8 enc_flags;
1597	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1598	union {
1599		struct {
1600			u8 he_ru:3;
1601			u8 he_gi:2;
1602			u8 he_dcm:1;
1603		};
1604		struct {
1605			u8 ru:4;
1606			u8 gi:2;
1607		} eht;
1608	};
1609	u8 rate_idx;
1610	u8 nss;
1611	u8 rx_flags;
1612	u8 band;
1613	u8 antenna;
1614	s8 signal;
1615	u8 chains;
1616	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1617	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1618	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1619	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1620};
1621
1622static inline u32
1623ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1624{
1625	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1626	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1627}
1628
1629/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1630 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1631 *
1632 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1633 *
1634 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1635 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1636 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1637 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1638 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1639 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1640 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1641 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1642 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1643 *	for more.
1644 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1645 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1646 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1647 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1648 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1649 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1650 *	operating channel.
1651 */
1652enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1653	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1654	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1655	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1656	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1657};
1658
1659
1660/**
1661 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1662 *
1663 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1664 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1665 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1666 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1667 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1668 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1669 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1670 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1671 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1672 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1673 */
1674enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1675	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1676	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1677	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1678	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1679	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1680	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1681	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1682	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1683};
1684
1685/**
1686 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1687 *
1688 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1689 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1690 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1691 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1692 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1693 */
1694enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1695	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1696	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1697	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1698	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1699
1700	/* keep last */
1701	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1702};
1703
1704/**
1705 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1706 *
1707 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1708 *
1709 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1710 *
1711 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1712 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1713 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1714 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1715 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1716 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1717 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1718 *
1719 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1720 *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1721 *
1722 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1723 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1724 *
1725 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1726 *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1727 *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1728 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1729 *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1730 *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1731 *
1732 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1733 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1734 *	configured for an HT channel.
1735 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1736 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1737 */
1738struct ieee80211_conf {
1739	u32 flags;
1740	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1741
1742	u16 listen_interval;
1743	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1744
1745	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1746
1747	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1748	bool radar_enabled;
1749	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1750};
1751
1752/**
1753 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1754 *
1755 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1756 * operation.
1757 *
1758 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1759 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1760 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1761 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1762 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1763 *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1764 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1765 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1766 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1767 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1768 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1769 *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1770 *	channel, expressed in TU.
1771 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1772 */
1773struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1774	u64 timestamp;
1775	u32 device_timestamp;
1776	bool block_tx;
1777	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1778	u8 count;
1779	u8 link_id;
1780	u32 delay;
1781};
1782
1783/**
1784 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1785 *
1786 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1787 *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1788 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1789 *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1790 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1791 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1792 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1793 *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1794 *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1795 *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1796 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1797 *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1798 *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1799 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1800 *      enabled for the interface.
1801 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1802 *	operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1803 *	the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1804 *	handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1805 */
1806enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1807	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1808	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1809	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1810	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1811	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1812	IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW	= BIT(5),
1813};
1814
1815
1816/**
1817 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1818 *
1819 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1820 *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1821 *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1822 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1823 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1824 *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1825 *	mac80211.
1826 */
1827
1828enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1829	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1830	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1831	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1832};
1833
1834/**
1835 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1836 * @assoc: association status
1837 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1838 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1839 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1840 *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1841 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1842 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1843 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1844 *	P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1845 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1846 *	Figure 9-1001k
1847 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1848 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1849 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1850 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1851 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1852 *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1853 *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1854 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1855 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1856 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1857 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1858 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1859 *	your driver/device needs to do.
1860 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1861 *	(station mode only)
1862 */
1863struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1864	/* association related data */
1865	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1866	bool ibss_creator;
1867	bool ps;
1868	u16 aid;
1869	u16 eml_cap;
1870	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1871	u16 mld_capa_op;
1872
1873	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1874	int arp_addr_cnt;
1875	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1876	size_t ssid_len;
1877	bool s1g;
1878	bool idle;
1879	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1880};
1881
1882#define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1883
1884/**
1885 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1886 *
1887 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1888 *	this TID is not included.
1889 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1890 *	TID is not included.
1891 * @valid: info is valid or not.
1892 */
1893struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1894	u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1895	u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1896	bool valid;
1897};
1898
1899/**
1900 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1901 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1902 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1903 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1904 */
1905enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1906	NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1907	NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1908	NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1909};
1910
1911/**
1912 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1913 *
1914 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1915 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1916 *
1917 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1918 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1919 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1920 *	or the BSS we're associated to
1921 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1922 *	indexed by link ID
1923 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1924 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1925 *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1926 *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1927 * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1928 *	Must be a subset of valid_links.
1929 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1930 *	suspended.
1931 *	0 for non-MLO.
1932 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1933 *	see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1934 * @addr: address of this interface
1935 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1936 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1937 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1938 *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1939 *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1940 *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1941 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1942 *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1943 *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1944 *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1945 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1946 *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1947 *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1948 *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1949 *	restrictions.
1950 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1951 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1952 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1953 *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1954 *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1955 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1956 *	interface.
1957 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1958 *	for this interface.
1959 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1960 *	sizeof(void \*).
1961 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1962 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1963 *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1964 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1965 */
1966struct ieee80211_vif {
1967	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1968	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1969	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1970	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1971	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
1972	struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
1973	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1974	bool p2p;
1975
1976	u8 cab_queue;
1977	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1978
1979	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1980
1981	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1982	u32 driver_flags;
1983	u32 offload_flags;
1984
1985#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1986	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1987#endif
1988
1989	bool probe_req_reg;
1990	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1991
1992	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1993
1994	/* must be last */
1995	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1996};
1997
1998/**
1999 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2000 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2001 * Return: the usable link bitmap
2002 */
2003static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2004{
2005	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2006}
2007
2008/**
2009 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2010 * @vif: the vif
2011 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2012 */
2013static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2014{
2015	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2016	return vif->valid_links != 0;
2017}
2018
2019/**
2020 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2021 * @vif: the vif
2022 * @link_id: the link ID to check
2023 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2024 *	the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2025 */
2026static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2027					     unsigned int link_id)
2028{
2029	if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2030		return link_id == 0;
2031	return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2032}
2033
2034#define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
2035	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
2036		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2037		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2038		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2039
2040static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2041{
2042#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2043	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2044#endif
2045	return false;
2046}
2047
2048/**
2049 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2050 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2051 *
2052 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2053 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2054 *
2055 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2056 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2057 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2058 */
2059struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2060
2061/**
2062 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2063 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2064 *
2065 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2066 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2067 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2068 */
2069struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2070
2071static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
 
 
 
 
2072{
2073	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2074}
2075
2076#define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
2077	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2078				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2079
2080#define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
2081	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2082			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2083
2084/**
2085 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2086 *
2087 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2088 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2089 *
2090 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2091 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2092 *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2093 *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2094 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2095 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2096 *	generation in software.
2097 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2098 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2099 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2100 *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2101 *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2102 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2103 *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2104 *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2105 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2106 *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2107 *	MIC.
2108 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2109 *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2110 *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2111 *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2112 *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2113 *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2114 *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2115 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2116 *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2117 *	only for management frames (MFP).
2118 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2119 *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2120 *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2121 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2122 *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2123 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2124 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2125 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2126 *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2127 *	generation only
2128 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2129 *	(set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2130 */
2131enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2132	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2133	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2134	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2135	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2136	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2137	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2138	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2139	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2140	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2141	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2142	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2143	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU		= BIT(11),
2144};
2145
2146/**
2147 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2148 *
2149 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2150 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2151 *
2152 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2153 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2154 *	encrypted in hardware.
2155 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2156 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2157 *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2158 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2159 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2160 * @keylen: key material length
2161 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2162 * 	data block:
2163 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2164 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2165 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2166 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2167 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2168 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2169 */
2170struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2171	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2172	u32 cipher;
2173	u8 icv_len;
2174	u8 iv_len;
2175	u8 hw_key_idx;
2176	s8 keyidx;
2177	u16 flags;
2178	s8 link_id;
2179	u8 keylen;
2180	u8 key[];
2181};
2182
2183#define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2184
2185#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2186#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2187
2188/**
2189 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2190 *
2191 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2192 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2193 *	reverse order than in packet)
2194 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2195 *	reverse order than in packet)
2196 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2197 *	reverse order than in packet)
2198 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2199 *	reverse order than in packet)
2200 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2201 */
2202struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2203	union {
2204		struct {
2205			u32 iv32;
2206			u16 iv16;
2207		} tkip;
2208		struct {
2209			u8 pn[6];
2210		} ccmp;
2211		struct {
2212			u8 pn[6];
2213		} aes_cmac;
2214		struct {
2215			u8 pn[6];
2216		} aes_gmac;
2217		struct {
2218			u8 pn[6];
2219		} gcmp;
2220		struct {
2221			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2222			u8 seq_len;
2223		} hw;
2224	};
2225};
2226
2227/**
2228 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2229 *
2230 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2231 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2232 *
2233 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2234 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2235 */
2236enum set_key_cmd {
2237	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2238};
2239
2240/**
2241 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2242 *
2243 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2244 *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2245 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2246 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2247 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2248 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2249 */
2250enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2251	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2252	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2253	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2254	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2255	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2256	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2257};
2258
2259/**
2260 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2261 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2262 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2263 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2264 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2265 *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2266 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2267 *
2268 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2269 *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2270 */
2271enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2272	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2273	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2274	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2275	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2276	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2277};
2278
2279/**
2280 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2281 *
2282 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2283 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2284 *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2285 */
2286struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2287	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2288	struct {
2289		s8 idx;
2290		u8 count;
2291		u8 count_cts;
2292		u8 count_rts;
2293		u16 flags;
2294	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2295};
2296
2297/**
2298 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2299 *
2300 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2301 *
2302 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2303 *	to the STA.
2304 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2305 *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2306 *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2307 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2308 *	per peer TPC.
2309 */
2310struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2311	s16 power;
2312	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2313};
2314
2315/**
2316 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2317 *
2318 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2319 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2320 *
2321 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2322 *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2323 *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2324 *
2325 *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2326 *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2327 *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2328 *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2329 *
2330 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2331 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2332 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2333 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2334 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2335 */
2336struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2337	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2338
2339	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2340	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2341};
2342
2343/**
2344 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2345 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2346 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2347 *
2348 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2349 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2350 *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2351 *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2352 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2353 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2354 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2355 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2356 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2357 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2358 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2359 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2360 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2361 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2362 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2363 *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2364 *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2365 *	the station moves to associated state.
2366 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2367 *
2368 */
2369struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2370	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2371
2372	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2373	u8 link_id;
2374	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2375
2376	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2377	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2378	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2379	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2380	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2381	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2382
2383	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2384
2385	u8 rx_nss;
2386	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2387	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2388};
2389
2390/**
2391 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2392 *
2393 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2394 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2395 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2396 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2397 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2398 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2399 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2400 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2401 *
2402 * @addr: MAC address
2403 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2404 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2405 *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2406 *	Can be modified by driver.
2407 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2408 *	otherwise always false)
2409 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2410 *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2411 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2412 *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2413 *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2414 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2415 * @rates: rate control selection table
2416 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2417 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2418 *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2419 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2420 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2421 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2422 *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2423 *	unlimited.
2424 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2425 *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2426 *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2427 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2428 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2429 *	is used for non-data frames
2430 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2431 *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2432 *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2433 *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2434 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2435 *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2436 *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2437 *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2438 *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2439 *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2440 *	by the AP.
2441 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2442 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2443 */
2444struct ieee80211_sta {
2445	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2446	u16 aid;
2447	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2448	bool wme;
2449	u8 uapsd_queues;
2450	u8 max_sp;
2451	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2452	bool tdls;
2453	bool tdls_initiator;
2454	bool mfp;
2455	bool mlo;
2456	bool spp_amsdu;
2457	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2458
2459	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2460
2461	bool support_p2p_ps;
2462
2463	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2464
2465	u16 valid_links;
2466	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2467	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2468
2469	/* must be last */
2470	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2471};
2472
2473#ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2474bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2475#else
2476static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2477{
2478	return true;
2479}
2480#endif
2481
2482#define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2483	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2484				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2485
2486#define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2487	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2488			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2489
2490#define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2491	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2492		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2493		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2494		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2495
2496/**
2497 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2498 *
2499 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2500 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2501 *
2502 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2503 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2504 */
2505enum sta_notify_cmd {
2506	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2507};
2508
2509/**
2510 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2511 *
2512 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2513 * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2514 */
2515struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2516	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2517};
2518
2519/**
2520 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2521 *
2522 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2523 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2524 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2525 *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2526 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2527 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2528 *
2529 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2530 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2531 */
2532struct ieee80211_txq {
2533	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2534	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2535	u8 tid;
2536	u8 ac;
2537
2538	/* must be last */
2539	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2540};
2541
2542/**
2543 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2544 *
2545 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2546 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2547 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2548 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2549 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2550 *
2551 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2552 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2553 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2554 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2555 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2556 *	algorithm.
2557 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2558 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2559 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2560 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2561 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2562 *	CCK frames.
2563 *
2564 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2565 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2566 *	the FCS at the end.
2567 *
2568 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2569 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2570 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2571 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2572 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2573 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2574 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2575 *
2576 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2577 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2578 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2579 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2580 *
2581 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2582 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2583 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2584 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2585 *
2586 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2587 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2588 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2589 *
2590 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2591 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2592 *
2593 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2594 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2595 *
2596 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2597 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2598 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2599 *
2600 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2601 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2602 *
2603 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2604 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2605 *
2606 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2607 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2608 *	the stack.
2609 *
2610 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2611 *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2612 *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2613 *
2614 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2615 *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2616 *	dtim_period).
2617 *
2618 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2619 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2620 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2621 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2622 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2623 *	only in that case.
2624 *
2625 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2626 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2627 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2628 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2629 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2630 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2631 *
2632 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2633 *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2634 *	software.
2635 *
2636 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2637 *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2638 *	active interfaces.
2639 *
2640 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2641 *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2642 *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2643 *
2644 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2645 *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2646 *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2647 *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2648 *	supported cipher suites.
2649 *
2650 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2651 *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2652 *	for frames.
2653 *
2654 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2655 *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2656 *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2657 *	control for more details.
2658 *
2659 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2660 *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2661 *
2662 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2663 *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2664 *	is supported.
2665 *
2666 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2667 *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2668 *
2669 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2670 *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2671 *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2672 *
2673 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2674 *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2675 *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2676 *	CSA frame.
2677 *
2678 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2679 *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2680 *
2681 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2682 *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2683 *
2684 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2685 *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2686 *
2687 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2688 *	within A-MPDU.
2689 *
2690 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2691 *	for sent beacons.
2692 *
2693 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2694 *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2695 *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2696 *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2697 *
2698 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2699 *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2700 *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2701 *	timeout.
2702 *
2703 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2704 *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2705 *
2706 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2707 *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2708 *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2709 *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2710 *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2711 *
2712 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2713 *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2714 *
2715 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2716 *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2717 *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2718 *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2719 *
2720 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2721 *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2722 *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2723 *
2724 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2725 *	TDLS links.
2726 *
2727 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2728 *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2729 *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2730 *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2731 *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2732 *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2733 *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2734 *
2735 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2736 *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2737 *
2738 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2739 *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2740 *
2741 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2742 *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2743 *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2744 *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2745 *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2746 *
2747 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2748 *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2749 *	TXQs to start with.
2750 *
2751 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2752 *	length in tx status information
2753 *
2754 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2755 *
2756 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2757 *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2758 *
2759 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2760 *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2761 *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2762 *
2763 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2764 *	offload
2765 *
2766 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2767 *	offload
2768 *
2769 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2770 *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2771 *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2772 *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2773 *	the stack.
2774 *
2775 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2776 *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2777 *
2778 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2779 *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2780 *
2781 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2782 *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2783 *
2784 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2785 *	no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2786 *	implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2787 *	link is switching.
2788 *
2789 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2790 */
2791enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2792	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2793	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2794	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2795	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2796	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2797	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2798	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2799	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2800	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2801	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2802	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2803	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2804	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2805	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2806	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2807	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2808	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2809	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2810	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2811	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2812	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2813	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2814	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2815	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2816	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2817	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2818	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2819	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2820	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2821	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2822	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2823	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2824	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2825	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2826	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2827	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2828	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2829	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2830	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2831	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2832	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2833	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2834	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2835	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2836	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2837	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2838	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2839	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2840	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2841	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2842	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2843	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2844	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2845	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2846	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2847	IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2848
2849	/* keep last, obviously */
2850	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2851};
2852
2853/**
2854 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2855 *
2856 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2857 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2858 *
2859 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2860 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2861 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2862 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2863 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2864 *
2865 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2866 *
2867 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2868 *	along with this structure.
2869 *
2870 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2871 *
2872 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2873 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2874 *
2875 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2876 *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2877 *
2878 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2879 *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2880 *
2881 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2882 *	that HW supports
2883 *
2884 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2885 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2886 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2887 *
2888 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2889 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2890 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2891 *
2892 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2893 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2894 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2895 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2896 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2897 *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2898 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2899 *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2900 *
2901 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2902 *	can handle.
2903 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2904 *	the hw can report back.
2905 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2906 *
2907 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2908 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2909 *	aggregation.
2910 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2911 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2912 *	it shouldn't be set.
2913 *
2914 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2915 *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2916 *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2917 *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2918 *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2919 *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2920 *
2921 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2922 *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2923 *
2924 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2925 *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2926 *
2927 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2928 *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2929 *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2930 *	adding _BW is supported today.
2931 *
2932 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2933 *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2934 *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2935 *
 
 
2936 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2937 *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2938 *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2939 *	device_timestamp.
2940 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2941 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2942 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2943 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2944 *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2945 *
2946 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2947 *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2948 *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2949 *
2950 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2951 *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2952 *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2953 *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2954 *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2955 *	neither enabled.
2956 *
2957 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2958 *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2959 *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2960 *
2961 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2962 *	device.
2963 *
2964 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2965 *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2966 *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2967 *
2968 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2969 *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2970 *
2971 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2972 *
2973 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2974 * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2975 * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2976 *
2977 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2978 */
2979struct ieee80211_hw {
2980	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2981	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2982	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2983	void *priv;
2984	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2985	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2986	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2987	int vif_data_size;
2988	int sta_data_size;
2989	int chanctx_data_size;
2990	int txq_data_size;
2991	u16 queues;
2992	u16 max_listen_interval;
2993	s8 max_signal;
2994	u8 max_rates;
2995	u8 max_report_rates;
2996	u8 max_rate_tries;
2997	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2998	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2999	u8 max_tx_fragments;
3000	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3001	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3002	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3003	struct {
3004		int units_pos;
3005		s16 accuracy;
3006	} radiotap_timestamp;
3007	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3008	u8 uapsd_queues;
3009	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3010	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3011	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3012	u8 weight_multiplier;
3013	u32 max_mtu;
3014	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3015	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3016};
3017
3018static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3019				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3020{
3021	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3022}
3023#define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3024
3025static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3026				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3027{
3028	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3029}
3030#define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3031
3032/**
3033 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3034 *
3035 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3036 * @req: cfg80211 request.
3037 */
3038struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3039	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3040
3041	/* Keep last */
3042	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3043};
3044
3045/**
3046 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3047 *
3048 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3049 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3050 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3051 * @status: channel-switch response status
3052 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3053 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3054 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3055 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3056 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3057 */
3058struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3059	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3060	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3061	u8 action_code;
3062	u32 status;
3063	u32 timestamp;
3064	u16 switch_time;
3065	u16 switch_timeout;
3066	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3067	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3068};
3069
3070/**
3071 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3072 *
3073 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3074 *
3075 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3076 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3077 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3078 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3079 * is already used internally by mac80211.
3080 *
3081 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3082 */
3083struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3084
3085/**
3086 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3087 *
3088 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3089 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3090 */
3091static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3092{
3093	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3094}
3095
3096/**
3097 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3098 *
3099 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3100 * @addr: the address to set
3101 */
3102static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3103{
3104	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3105}
3106
3107static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3108ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3109		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3110{
3111	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3112		return NULL;
3113	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3114}
3115
3116static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3117ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3118			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3119{
3120	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3121		return NULL;
3122	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3123}
3124
3125static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3126ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3127			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3128{
3129	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3130		return NULL;
3131	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3132}
3133
3134/**
3135 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3136 * @hw: the hardware
3137 * @skb: the skb
3138 *
3139 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3140 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3141 */
3142void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3143
3144/**
3145 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3146 *
3147 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3148 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3149 *
3150 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3151 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3152 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3153 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3154 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3155 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3156 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3157 *
3158 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3159 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3160 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3161 *
3162 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3163 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3164 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3165 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3166 *
3167 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3168 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3169 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3170 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3171 *
3172 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3173 *
3174 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3175 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3176 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3177 * based on the receive flags.
3178 *
3179 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3180 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3181 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3182 * keys.
3183 *
3184 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3185 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3186 * handler.
3187 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3188 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3189 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3190 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3191 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3192 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3193 *
3194 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3195 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3196 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3197 *
3198 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3199 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3200 * requirements:
3201 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3202      once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3203   2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3204      at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3205   3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3206      encrypted with the new key when also needing
3207      @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3208   4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3209   Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3210 */
3211
3212/**
3213 * DOC: Powersave support
3214 *
3215 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3216 *
3217 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3218 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3219 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3220 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3221 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3222 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3223 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3224 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3225 *
3226 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3227 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3228 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3229 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3230 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3231 *
3232 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3233 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3234 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3235 *
3236 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3237 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3238 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3239 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3240 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3241 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3242 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3243 *
3244 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3245 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3246 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3247 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3248 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3249 * periods.
3250 *
3251 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3252 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3253 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3254 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3255 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3256 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3257 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3258 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3259 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3260 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3261 *
3262 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3263 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3264 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3265 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3266 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3267 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3268 *
3269 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3270 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3271 */
3272
3273/**
3274 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3275 *
3276 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3277 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3278 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3279 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3280 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3281 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3282 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3283 *
3284 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3285 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3286 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3287 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3288 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3289 *
3290 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3291 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3292 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3293 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3294 *
3295 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3296 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3297 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3298 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3299 *
3300 *  - a list of information element IDs
3301 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3302 *
3303 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3304 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3305 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3306 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3307 * vendor information elements.
3308 *
3309 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3310 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3311 *
3312 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3313 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3314 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3315 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3316 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3317 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3318 *
3319 *
3320 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3321 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3322 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3323 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3324 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3325 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3326 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3327 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3328 *
3329 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3330 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3331 * signal strength threshold checking.
3332 */
3333
3334/**
3335 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3336 *
3337 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3338 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3339 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3340 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3341 *
3342 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3343 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3344 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3345 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3346 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3347 * hardware flags.
3348 *
3349 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3350 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3351 * turned off otherwise.
3352 *
3353 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3354 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3355 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3356 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3357 */
3358
3359/**
3360 * DOC: Frame filtering
3361 *
3362 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3363 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3364 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3365 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3366 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3367 *
3368 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3369 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3370 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3371 *
3372 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3373 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3374 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3375 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3376 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3377 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3378 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3379 *
3380 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3381 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3382 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3383 * or dropped.
3384 *
3385 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3386 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3387 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3388 * the flag, but not clear it.
3389 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3390 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3391 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3392 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3393 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3394 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3395 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3396 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3397 */
3398
3399/**
3400 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3401 *
3402 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3403 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3404 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3405 *
3406 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3407 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3408 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3409 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3410 * the driver code.
3411 *
3412 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3413 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3414 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3415 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3416 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3417 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3418 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3419 *
3420 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3421 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3422 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3423 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3424 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3425 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3426 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3427 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3428 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3429 * @sta_notify callback.
3430 *
3431 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3432 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3433 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3434 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3435 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3436 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3437 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3438 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3439 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3440 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3441 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3442 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3443 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3444 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3445 *
3446 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3447 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3448 *
3449 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3450 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3451 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3452 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3453 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3454 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3455 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3456 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3457 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3458 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3459 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3460 *
3461 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3462 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3463 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3464 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3465 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3466 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3467 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3468 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3469 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3470 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3471 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3472 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3473 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3474 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3475 *
3476 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3477 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3478 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3479 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3480 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3481 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3482 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3483 *
3484 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3485 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3486 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3487 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3488 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3489 *
3490 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3491 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3492 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3493 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3494 */
3495
3496/**
3497 * DOC: HW queue control
3498 *
3499 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3500 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3501 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3502 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3503 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3504 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3505 *
3506 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3507 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3508 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3509 *
3510 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3511 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3512 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3513 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3514 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3515 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3516 * the hardware queue.
3517 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3518 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3519 *
3520 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3521 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3522 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3523 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3524 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3525 *
3526 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3527 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3528 * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3529 * off-channel queue:         9
3530 *
3531 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3532 *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3533 *
3534 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3535 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3536 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3537 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3538 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3539 *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3540 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3541 *
3542 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3543 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3544 *
3545 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3546 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3547 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3548 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3549 */
3550
3551/**
3552 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3553 *
3554 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3555 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3556 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3557 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3558 *
3559 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3560 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3561 *	multicast address.
3562 *
3563 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3564 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3565 *
3566 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3567 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3568 *
3569 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3570 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3571 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3572 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3573 *	honour this flag if possible.
3574 *
3575 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3576 *	station
3577 *
3578 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3579 *
3580 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3581 *
3582 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3583 *
3584 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3585 */
3586enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3587	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3588	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3589	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3590	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3591	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3592	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3593	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3594	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3595	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3596};
3597
3598/**
3599 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3600 *
3601 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3602 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3603 *
3604 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3605 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3606 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3607 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3608 *
3609 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3610 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3611 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3612 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3613 *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3614 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3615 *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3616 *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3617 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3618 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3619 *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3620 *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3621 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3622 *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3623 *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3624 *	session is gone and removes the station.
3625 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3626 *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3627 *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3628 *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3629 */
3630enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3631	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3632	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3633	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3634	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3635	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3636	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3637	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3638};
3639
3640#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3641#define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3642
3643/**
3644 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3645 *
3646 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3647 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3648 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3649 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3650 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3651 *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3652 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3653 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3654 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3655 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3656 *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3657 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3658 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3659 */
3660struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3661	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3662	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3663	u16 tid;
3664	u16 ssn;
3665	u16 buf_size;
3666	bool amsdu;
3667	u16 timeout;
3668};
3669
3670/**
3671 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3672 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3673 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3674 *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3675 */
3676enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3677	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3678	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3679};
3680
3681/**
3682 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3683 *
3684 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3685 *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3686 *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3687 *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3688 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3689 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3690 *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3691 *	the peer.
3692 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3693 *	by the peer
3694 */
3695enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3696	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3697	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3698	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3699	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3700};
3701
3702/**
3703 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3704 *
3705 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3706 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3707 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3708 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3709 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3710 *
3711 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3712 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3713 *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3714 */
3715enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3716	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3717	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3718};
3719
3720/**
3721 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3722 *
3723 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3724 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3725 *
3726 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3727 *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3728 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3729 *	of wowlan configuration)
3730 */
3731enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3732	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3733	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3734};
3735
3736/**
3737 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3738 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3739 *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3740 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3741 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3742 *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3743 *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3744 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3745 *	Only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3746 */
3747struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3748	u16 duration;
3749	u16 subtype;
3750	u8 success:1;
3751	int link_id;
3752};
3753
3754/**
3755 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3756 *
3757 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3758 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3759 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3760 *
3761 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3762 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3763 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3764 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3765 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3766 *	Must be atomic.
3767 *
3768 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3769 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3770 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3771 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3772 *	or zero.
3773 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3774 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3775 *	is added.
3776 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3777 *
3778 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3779 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3780 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3781 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3782 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3783 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3784 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3785 *
3786 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3787 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3788 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3789 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3790 *	reconfigured at resume time.
3791 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3792 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3793 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3794 *	must return 1 from this function.
3795 *
3796 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3797 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3798 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3799 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3800 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3801 *
3802 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3803 *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3804 *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3805 *	in suspend().
3806 *
3807 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3808 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3809 *	and @stop must be implemented.
3810 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3811 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3812 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3813 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3814 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3815 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3816 *
3817 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3818 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3819 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3820 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3821 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3822 *
3823 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3824 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3825 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3826 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3827 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3828 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3829 *	MAC address of the device going away.
3830 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3831 *
3832 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3833 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3834 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3835 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3836 *
3837 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3838 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3839 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3840 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3841 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3842 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3843 *	can sleep.
3844 *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3845 *	are not implemented.
3846 *
3847 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3848 *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3849 *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3850 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3851 *	The callback can sleep.
3852 *
3853 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3854 *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3855 *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3856 *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3857 *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3858 *	non-MLO connections.
3859 *	The callback can sleep.
3860 *
3861 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3862 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3863 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3864 *
3865 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3866 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3867 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3868 *
3869 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3870 *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3871 *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3872 *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3873 *	which flags are changed.
3874 *	This callback can sleep.
3875 *
3876 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3877 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3878 *
3879 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3880 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3881 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3882 *	is enabled.
3883 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3884 *	The callback can sleep.
3885 *
3886 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3887 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3888 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3889 *	The callback must be atomic.
3890 *
3891 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3892 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3893 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3894 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3895 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3896 *
3897 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3898 *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3899 *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3900 *
3901 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3902 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3903 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3904 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3905 *	that power save is disabled.
3906 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3907 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3908 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3909 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3910 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3911 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3912 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3913 *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3914 *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3915 *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3916 *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3917 *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3918 *	The callback can sleep.
3919 *
3920 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3921 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3922 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3923 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3924 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3925 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3926 *	The callback can sleep.
3927 *
3928 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3929 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3930 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3931 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3932 *
3933 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3934 *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3935 *
3936 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3937 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3938 *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3939 *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3940 *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3941 *
3942 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3943 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3944 *	this notification.
3945 *	The callback can sleep.
3946 *
3947 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3948 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3949 *	The callback can sleep.
3950 *
3951 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3952 *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3953 *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3954 *	The callback must be atomic.
3955 *
3956 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3957 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3958 *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3959 *	should be set as well.
3960 *	The callback can sleep.
3961 *
3962 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3963 *	The callback can sleep.
3964 *
3965 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3966 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3967 *
3968 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3969 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3970 *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3971 *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3972 *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3973 *	This callback can sleep.
3974 *
3975 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
3976 *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
3977 *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3978 *
3979 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3980 *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3981 *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3982 *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3983 *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3984 *
3985 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3986 *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3987 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3988 *	callback can sleep.
3989 *
3990 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3991 *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3992 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3993 *	callback can sleep.
3994 *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3995 *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3996 *
3997 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3998 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3999 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4000 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4001 *
4002 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4003 *	power for the station.
4004 *	This callback can sleep.
4005 *
4006 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4007 *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4008 *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4009 *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4010 *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4011 *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4012 *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4013 *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4014 *	The callback can sleep.
4015 *
4016 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4017 *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4018 *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4019 *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4020 *	in @sta_state.
4021 *	The callback can sleep.
4022 *
4023 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
4024 *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4025 *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4026 *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4027 *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4028 *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4029 *	Must be atomic.
4030 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4031 *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4032 *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4033 *
4034 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4035 *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4036 *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4037 *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4038 *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4039 *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4040 *	The callback can sleep.
4041 *
4042 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4043 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4044 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
4045 *	The callback can sleep.
4046 *
4047 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4048 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4049 *	required function.
4050 *	The callback can sleep.
4051 *
4052 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4053 *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4054 *	required function.
4055 *	The callback can sleep.
4056 *
4057 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4058 *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4059 *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4060 *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4061 *	The callback can sleep.
4062 *
4063 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4064 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4065 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4066 *	TSF synchronization.
4067 *	The callback can sleep.
4068 *
4069 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4070 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4071 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4072 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4073 *	The callback can sleep.
4074 *
4075 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4076 *
4077 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4078 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4079 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4080 *	The callback can sleep.
4081 *
4082 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4083 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4084 *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4085 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4086 *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4087 *
4088 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4089 *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4090 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4091 *
4092 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4093 *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4094 *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4095 *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4096 *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4097 *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4098 *	The callback can sleep.
4099 *
4100 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4101 *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4102 *	The callback can sleep.
4103 *
4104 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4105 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4106 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4107 *	completion of the channel switch.
4108 *
4109 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4110 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4111 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4112 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4113 *
4114 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4115 *
4116 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4117 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4118 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4119 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4120 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4121 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4122 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4123 *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4124 *	must be accepted in this case.
4125 *	This callback may sleep.
4126 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4127 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4128 *
4129 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4130 *
4131 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4132 *
4133 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4134 *	queues before entering power save.
4135 *
4136 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4137 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4138 *	The callback can sleep.
4139 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4140 *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4141 *	The callback must be atomic.
4142 *
4143 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4144 *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4145 *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4146 *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4147 *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4148 *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4149 *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4150 *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4151 *	more-data bit must always be set.
4152 *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4153 *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4154 *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4155 *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4156 *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4157 *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4158 *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4159 *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4160 *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4161 *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4162 *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4163 *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4164 *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4165 *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4166 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4167 *	This callback must be atomic.
4168 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4169 *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4170 *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4171 *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4172 *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4173 *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4174 *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4175 *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4176 *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4177 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4178 *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4179 *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4180 *	This callback must be atomic.
4181 *
4182 * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4183 *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4184 *	expected to return a static value.
4185 *
4186 * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4187 *
4188 * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4189 *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4190 *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4191 *	expected to return a static value.
4192 *
4193 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4194 *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4195 *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4196 *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4197 *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4198 *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4199 *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4200 *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4201 *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4202 *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4203 *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4204 *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4205 *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4206 *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4207 *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4208 *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4209 *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4210 *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4211 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4212 *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4213 *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4214 *
4215 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4216 *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4217 *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4218 *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4219 *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4220 *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4221 *	2 * (DTIM period).
4222 *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4223 *
4224 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4225 *	This callback may sleep.
4226 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4227 *	This callback may sleep.
4228 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4229 *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4230 *	channel context with different settings
4231 *	This callback may sleep.
4232 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4233 *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4234 *	This callback may sleep.
4235 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4236 *	unbound from vif.
4237 *	This callback may sleep.
4238 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4239 *	another, as specified in the list of
4240 *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4241 *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4242 *	This callback may sleep.
4243 *
4244 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4245 *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4246 *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4247 *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4248 *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4249 *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4250 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4251 *
4252 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4253 *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4254 *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4255 *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4256 *	This callback may sleep.
4257 *
4258 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4259 *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4260 *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4261 *
4262 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4263 *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4264 *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4265 *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4266 *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4267 *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4268 *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4269 *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4270 *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4271 *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4272 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4273 *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4274 *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4275 *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4276 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4277 *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4278 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4279 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4280 *	when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4281 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4282 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4283 *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4284 *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4285 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4286 *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4287 *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4288 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4289 *
4290 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4291 *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4292 *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4293 *
4294 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4295 *	and hardware limits.
4296 *
4297 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4298 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4299 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4300 *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4301 *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4302 *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4303 *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4304 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4305 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4306 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4307 *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4308 *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4309 *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4310 *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4311 *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4312 *	the function call.
4313 *
4314 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4315 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4316 *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4317 *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4318 *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4319 *
4320 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4321 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4322 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4323 *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4324 *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4325 *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4326 *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4327 *	changed parameters.
4328 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4329 *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4330 *	this call.
4331 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4332 *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4333 *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4334 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4335 *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4336 *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4337 *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4338 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4339 *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4340 *
4341 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4342 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4343 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4344 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4345 *	This callback may sleep.
4346 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4347 *	This callback may sleep.
4348 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4349 *	4-address mode
4350 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4351 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4352 *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4353 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4354 *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4355 *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4356 *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4357 *	twt structure.
4358 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4359 *	from the peer.
4360 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4361 *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4362 *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4363 *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4364 *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4365 *	radar channel.
4366 *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4367 *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4368 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4369 *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4370 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4371 *	supported by the driver.
4372 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4373 *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4374 *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4375 *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4376 *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4377 *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4378 *	This callback can sleep.
4379 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4380 *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4381 *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4382 *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4383 *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4384 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4385 *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4386 *	that.
4387 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4388 *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4389 *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4390 *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4391 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4392 *	if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4393 *	If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4394 *	modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4395 */
4396struct ieee80211_ops {
4397	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4398		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4399		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4400	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4401	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4402#ifdef CONFIG_PM
4403	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4404	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4405	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4406#endif
4407	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4408			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4409	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4410				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4411				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4412	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4413				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4414	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4415	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4416				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4417				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4418				 u64 changed);
4419	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4420				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4421				u64 changed);
4422	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4423				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4424				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4425				  u64 changed);
4426
4427	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4428			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4429	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4430			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4431
4432	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4433				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4434	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4435				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4436				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4437				 u64 multicast);
4438	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4439				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4440				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4441				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4442	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4443		       bool set);
4444	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4445		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4446		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4447	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4448				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4449				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4450				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4451				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4452	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4453			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4454			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4455	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4456					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4457	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4458		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4459	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4460			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4461	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4462				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4463				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4464				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4465	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4466			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4467	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4468			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4469			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4470	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4471				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4472	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4473			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4474	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4475			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4476			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4477	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4478	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4479	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4480		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4481	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4482			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4483#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4484	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4485				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4486	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4488				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4489				 struct dentry *dir);
4490	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4491				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4492				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4493				struct dentry *dir);
4494	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4495				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4496				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4497				     struct dentry *dir);
4498#endif
4499	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4500			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4501	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4502			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4503			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4504	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4505			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4506			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4507			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4508	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4509				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4510				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4511	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4512			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4513			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4514			      u32 changed);
4515	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4516				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4517				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4518	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4519			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4520			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4521			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4522	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4524		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4525		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4526	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4527	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4528			u64 tsf);
4529	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4530			   s64 offset);
4531	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4532	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4533
4534	/**
4535	 * @ampdu_action:
4536	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4537	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4538	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4539	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4540	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4541	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4542	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4543	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4544	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4545	 *
4546	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4547	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4548	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4549	 *
4550	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4551	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4552	 *
4553	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4554	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4555	 * - ``TX:        81``
4556	 *
4557	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4558	 *
4559	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4560	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4561	 * if the session can start immediately.
4562	 *
4563	 * The callback can sleep.
4564	 */
4565	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4566			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4567			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4568	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4569		struct survey_info *survey);
4570	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4571	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4572#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4573	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4574			    void *data, int len);
4575	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4576			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4577			     void *data, int len);
4578#endif
4579	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4580		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4581	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4582			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4583	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4584			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4585			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4586	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4587	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4588
4589	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4590				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4591				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4592				 int duration,
4593				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4594	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4596	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4597	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4598			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4599	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4600	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4601				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4602	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4603			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4604			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4605
4606	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4607				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4608				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4609				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4610				      bool more_data);
4611	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4612					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4613					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4614					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4615					bool more_data);
4616
4617	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4618				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4619	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4620				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4621				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4622	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4623				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4624				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4625
4626	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4627				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4628				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4629	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4630				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4631				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4632
4633	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4634					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4635					     unsigned int link_id);
4636
4637	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4638			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4639	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4640			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4641	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4642			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4643			       u32 changed);
4644	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4645				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4646				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4647				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4648	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4649				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4650				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4651				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4652	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4653				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4654				  int n_vifs,
4655				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4656
4657	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4658				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4659
4660#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4661	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4662				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4663				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4664#endif
4665	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4666				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4667				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4668	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4669				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4670				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4671
4672	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4673				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4674				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4675	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4676				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4677				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4678	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4679					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4680					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4681
4682	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4683	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4684	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4685				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4686	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4687			   int *dbm);
4688
4689	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4690				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4691				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4692				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4693				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4694	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4695					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4696					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4697	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4698					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4699					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4700
4701	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4702			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4703	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4704
4705	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4706			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4707			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4708	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4709			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4710	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4711			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4712			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4713	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4714			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4715			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4716	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4717			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4718			    u8 instance_id);
4719	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4720				       struct sk_buff *head,
4721				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4722	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4723				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4724				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4725	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4726			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4727	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4728			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4729	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4730			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4731			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4732			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4733	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4734				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4735				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4736	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4737				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4738	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4739			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4740	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4741			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4742	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4743				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4744				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4745	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4746			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4747			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4748	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4749				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4750	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4751				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4752	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4753				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4754				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4755				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4756				     struct net_device_path *path);
4757	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4758				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4759				   u16 active_links);
4760	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4761				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4762				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4763				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4764	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4765				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4766				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4767				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4768	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4769				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4770				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4771	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4772			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4773			    struct net_device *dev,
4774			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4775			    void *type_data);
4776	enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4777	(*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4778			struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4779};
4780
4781/**
4782 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4783 *
4784 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4785 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4786 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4787 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4788 * @priv_data_len.
4789 *
4790 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4791 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4792 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4793 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4794 *
4795 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4796 */
4797struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4798					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4799					   const char *requested_name);
4800
4801/**
4802 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4803 *
4804 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4805 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4806 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4807 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4808 * @priv_data_len.
4809 *
4810 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4811 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4812 *
4813 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4814 */
4815static inline
4816struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4817					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4818{
4819	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4820}
4821
4822/**
4823 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4824 *
4825 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4826 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4827 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4828 *
4829 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4830 *
4831 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4832 */
4833int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4834
4835/**
4836 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4837 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4838 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4839 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4840 */
4841struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4842	int throughput;
4843	int blink_time;
4844};
4845
4846/**
4847 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4848 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4849 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4850 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4851 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4852 */
4853enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4854	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4855	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4856	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4857};
4858
4859#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4860const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4861const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4862const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4863const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4864const char *
4865__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4866				   unsigned int flags,
4867				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4868				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4869#endif
4870/**
4871 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4872 *
4873 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4874 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4875 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4876 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4877 *
4878 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4879 *
4880 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4881 */
4882static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4883{
4884#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4885	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4886#else
4887	return NULL;
4888#endif
4889}
4890
4891/**
4892 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4893 *
4894 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4895 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4896 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4897 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4898 *
4899 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4900 *
4901 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4902 */
4903static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4904{
4905#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4906	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4907#else
4908	return NULL;
4909#endif
4910}
4911
4912/**
4913 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4914 *
4915 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4916 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4917 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4918 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4919 *
4920 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4921 *
4922 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4923 */
4924static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4925{
4926#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4927	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4928#else
4929	return NULL;
4930#endif
4931}
4932
4933/**
4934 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4935 *
4936 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4937 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4938 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4939 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4940 *
4941 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4942 *
4943 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4944 */
4945static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4946{
4947#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4948	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4949#else
4950	return NULL;
4951#endif
4952}
4953
4954/**
4955 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4956 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4957 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4958 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4959 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4960 *
4961 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4962 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4963 *
4964 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4965 */
4966static inline const char *
4967ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4968				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4969				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4970{
4971#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4972	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4973						  blink_table_len);
4974#else
4975	return NULL;
4976#endif
4977}
4978
4979/**
4980 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4981 *
4982 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4983 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4984 *
4985 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4986 */
4987void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4988
4989/**
4990 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4991 *
4992 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4993 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4994 * before calling this function.
4995 *
4996 * @hw: the hardware to free
4997 */
4998void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4999
5000/**
5001 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5002 *
5003 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5004 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5005 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5006 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5007 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5008 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5009 *
5010 * @hw: the hardware to restart
5011 */
5012void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5013
5014/**
5015 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5016 *
5017 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5018 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5019 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5020 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5021 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5022 *
5023 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5024 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5025 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5026 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5027 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5028 *
5029 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5030 *
5031 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5032 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5033 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5034 * @list: the destination list
5035 */
5036void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5037		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5038
5039/**
5040 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5041 *
5042 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5043 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5044 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5045 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5046 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5047 *
5048 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5049 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5050 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5051 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5052 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5053 *
5054 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5055 *
5056 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5057 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5058 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5059 * @napi: the NAPI context
5060 */
5061void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5062		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5063
5064/**
5065 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5066 *
5067 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5068 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5069 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5070 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5071 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5072 *
5073 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5074 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5075 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5076 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5077 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5078 *
5079 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5080 *
5081 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5082 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5083 */
5084static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5085{
5086	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5087}
5088
5089/**
5090 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5091 *
5092 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5093 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5094 *
5095 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5096 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5097 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5098 *
5099 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5100 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5101 */
5102void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5103
5104/**
5105 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5106 *
5107 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5108 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5109 *
5110 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5111 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5112 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5113 *
5114 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5115 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5116 */
5117static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5118				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5119{
5120	local_bh_disable();
5121	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5122	local_bh_enable();
5123}
5124
5125/**
5126 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5127 *
5128 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5129 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5130 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5131 *
5132 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5133 *
5134 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5135 * each other.
5136 *
5137 * @sta: currently connected sta
5138 * @start: start or stop PS
5139 *
5140 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5141 */
5142int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5143
5144/**
5145 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5146 *                                  (in process context)
5147 *
5148 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5149 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5150 * applies.
5151 *
5152 * @sta: currently connected sta
5153 * @start: start or stop PS
5154 *
5155 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5156 */
5157static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5158						  bool start)
5159{
5160	int ret;
5161
5162	local_bh_disable();
5163	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5164	local_bh_enable();
5165
5166	return ret;
5167}
5168
5169/**
5170 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5171 * @sta: currently connected station
5172 *
5173 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5174 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5175 * connected station was received.
5176 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5177 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5178 * be serialized.
5179 */
5180void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5181
5182/**
5183 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5184 * @sta: currently connected station
5185 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5186 *
5187 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5188 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5189 * from a connected station was received.
5190 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5191 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5192 * serialized.
5193 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5194 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5195 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5196 * checks.
5197 */
5198void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5199
5200/*
5201 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5202 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5203 */
5204#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5205
5206/**
5207 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5208 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5209 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5210 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5211 *
5212 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5213 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5214 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5215 *
5216 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5217 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5218 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5219 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5220 *
5221 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5222 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5223 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5224 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5225 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5226 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5227 *
5228 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5229 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5230 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5231 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5232 * use this API.
5233 */
5234void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5235				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5236
5237/**
5238 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5239 *
5240 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5241 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5242 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5243 *
5244 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5245 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5246 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5247 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5248 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5249 */
5250void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5251			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5252			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5253			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5254			    int max_rates);
5255
5256/**
5257 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5258 *
5259 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5260 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5261 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5262 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5263 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5264 * slow stations to starve).
5265 *
5266 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5267 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5268 */
5269void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5270					   u32 thr);
5271
5272/**
5273 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5274 *
5275 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5276 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5277 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5278 *
5279 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5280 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5281 * @info: tx status information
5282 */
5283void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5284			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5285			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5286
5287/**
5288 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5289 *
5290 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5291 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5292 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5293 *
5294 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5295 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5296 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5297 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5298 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5299 *
5300 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5301 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5302 */
5303void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5304			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5305
5306/**
5307 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5308 *
5309 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5310 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5311 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5312 *
5313 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5314 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5315 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5316 *
5317 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5318 * @status: tx status information
5319 */
5320void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5321			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5322
5323/**
5324 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5325 *
5326 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5327 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5328 * specific skbs.
5329 *
5330 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5331 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5332 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5333 *
5334 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5335 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5336 *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5337 * @info: tx status information
5338 */
5339static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5340					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5341					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5342{
5343	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5344		.sta = sta,
5345		.info = info,
5346	};
5347
5348	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5349}
5350
5351/**
5352 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5353 *
5354 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5355 *
5356 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5357 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5358 * for a single hardware.
5359 *
5360 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5361 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5362 */
5363static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5364					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5365{
5366	local_bh_disable();
5367	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5368	local_bh_enable();
5369}
5370
5371/**
5372 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5373 *
5374 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5375 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5376 *
5377 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5378 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5379 *
5380 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5381 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5382 */
5383void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5384				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5385
5386/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5387 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5388 *
5389 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5390 * connected STA.
5391 *
5392 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5393 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5394 */
5395void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5396
5397#define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5398
5399/**
5400 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5401 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5402 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5403 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5404 *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5405 *	should be ignored.
5406 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5407 */
5408struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5409	u16 tim_offset;
5410	u16 tim_length;
5411
5412	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5413	u16 mbssid_off;
5414};
5415
5416/**
5417 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5418 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5419 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5420 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5421 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5422 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5423 *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5424 *
5425 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5426 * obtain the beacon template.
5427 *
5428 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5429 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5430 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5431 * applicable, the CSA count.
5432 *
5433 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5434 *
5435 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5436 */
5437struct sk_buff *
5438ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5439			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5440			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5441			      unsigned int link_id);
5442
5443/**
5444 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5445 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5446 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5447 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5448 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5449 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5450 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5451 *
5452 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5453 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5454 * requested index.
5455 *
5456 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5457 */
5458struct sk_buff *
5459ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5460					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5461					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5462					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5463
5464/**
5465 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5466 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5467 *
5468 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5469 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5470 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5471 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5472 */
5473struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5474	u8 cnt;
5475	struct {
5476		struct sk_buff *skb;
5477		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5478	} bcn[];
5479};
5480
5481/**
5482 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5483 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5484 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5485 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5486 *
5487 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5488 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5489 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5490 * one multiple BSSID element.
5491 *
5492 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5493 *
5494 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5495 *	%NULL on error.
5496 */
5497struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5498ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5499				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5500				       unsigned int link_id);
5501
5502/**
5503 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5504 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5505 *
5506 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5507 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5508 */
5509void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5510
5511/**
5512 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5513 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5514 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5515 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5516 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5517 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5518 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5519 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5520 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5521 *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5522 *
5523 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5524 * obtain the beacon frame.
5525 *
5526 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5527 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5528 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5529 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5530 *
5531 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5532 *
5533 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5534 */
5535struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5536					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5537					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5538					 unsigned int link_id);
5539
5540/**
5541 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5542 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5543 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5544 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5545 *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5546 *
5547 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5548 *
5549 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5550 */
5551static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5552						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5553						   unsigned int link_id)
5554{
5555	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5556}
5557
5558/**
5559 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5560 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5561 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5562 *
5563 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5564 * This function is called implicitly when
5565 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5566 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5567 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5568 *
5569 * Return: new countdown value
5570 */
5571u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5572				  unsigned int link_id);
5573
5574/**
5575 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5576 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5577 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5578 *
5579 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5580 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5581 *
5582 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5583 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5584 */
5585void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5586
5587/**
5588 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5589 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5590 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5591 *
5592 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5593 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5594 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5595 */
5596void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5597
5598/**
5599 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5600 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5601 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5602 *
5603 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5604 */
5605bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5606					 unsigned int link_id);
5607
5608/**
5609 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5610 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5611 *
5612 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5613 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5614 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5615 */
5616void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5617
5618/**
5619 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5620 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5621 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5622 *
5623 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5624 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5625 *
5626 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5627 *
5628 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5629 */
5630struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5631					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5632
5633/**
5634 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5635 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5636 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5637 *
5638 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5639 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5640 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5641 *
5642 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5643 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5644 *
5645 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5646 */
5647struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5648				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5649
5650/**
5651 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5652 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5653 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5654 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5655 *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5656 *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5657 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5658 *	if at all possible
5659 *
5660 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5661 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5662 * BSSID and address is used.
5663 *
5664 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5665 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5666 *
5667 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5668 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5669 *
5670 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5671 */
5672struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5673				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5674				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5675
5676/**
5677 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5678 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5679 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5680 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5681 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5682 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5683 *
5684 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5685 * hardware.
5686 *
5687 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5688 */
5689struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5690				       const u8 *src_addr,
5691				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5692				       size_t tailroom);
5693
5694/**
5695 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5696 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5697 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5698 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5699 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5700 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5701 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5702 *
5703 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5704 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5705 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5706 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5707 */
5708void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5709		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5710		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5711		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5712
5713/**
5714 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5715 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5716 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5717 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5718 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5719 *
5720 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5721 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5722 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5723 *
5724 * Return: The duration.
5725 */
5726__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5727			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5728			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5729
5730/**
5731 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5732 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5733 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5734 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5735 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5736 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5737 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5738 *
5739 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5740 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5741 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5742 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5743 */
5744void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5745			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5746			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5747			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5748			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5749
5750/**
5751 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5752 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5753 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5754 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5755 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5756 *
5757 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5758 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5759 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5760 *
5761 * Return: The duration.
5762 */
5763__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5764				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5765				    size_t frame_len,
5766				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5767
5768/**
5769 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5770 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5771 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5772 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5773 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5774 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5775 *
5776 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5777 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5778 *
5779 * Return: The duration.
5780 */
5781__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5782					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5783					enum nl80211_band band,
5784					size_t frame_len,
5785					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5786
5787/**
5788 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5789 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5790 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5791 *
5792 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5793 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5794 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5795 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5796 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5797 *
5798 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5799 * frames are available.
5800 *
5801 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5802 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5803 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5804 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5805 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5806 * use common code for all beacons.
5807 */
5808struct sk_buff *
5809ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5810
5811/**
5812 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5813 *
5814 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5815 *
5816 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5817 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5818 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5819 */
5820void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5821			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5822
5823/**
5824 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5825 *
5826 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5827 * from the given packet.
5828 *
5829 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5830 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5831 *	with this P1K
5832 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5833 */
5834static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5835					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5836{
5837	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5838	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5839	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5840
5841	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5842}
5843
5844/**
5845 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5846 *
5847 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5848 * and transmitter address.
5849 *
5850 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5851 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5852 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5853 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5854 */
5855void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5856			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5857
5858/**
5859 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5860 *
5861 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5862 * in the packet.
5863 *
5864 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5865 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5866 *	encrypted with this key
5867 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5868 */
5869void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5870			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5871
5872/**
5873 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5874 *
5875 * @pos: start of crypto header
5876 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5877 * @pn: PN to add
5878 *
5879 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5880 * the packet payload)
5881 *
5882 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5883 * point to the crypto header)
5884 */
5885u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5886
5887/**
5888 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5889 *
5890 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5891 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5892 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5893 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5894 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5895 *
5896 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5897 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5898 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5899 *
5900 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5901 * can be done concurrently.
5902 */
5903void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5904			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5905
5906/**
5907 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5908 *
5909 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5910 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5911 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5912 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5913 * @seq: new sequence data
5914 *
5915 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5916 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5917 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5918 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5919 *
5920 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5921 * can be done concurrently.
5922 */
5923void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5924			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5925
5926/**
5927 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5928 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5929 *
5930 * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
5931 *
5932 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5933 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5934 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
 
 
 
5935 */
5936void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5937
5938/**
5939 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5940 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5941 * @keyconf: new key data
5942 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
5943 *
5944 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5945 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5946 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5947 *
5948 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5949 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5950 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5951 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5952 *
5953 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5954 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5955 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5956 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5957 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5958 * of the reconfiguration.
5959 *
5960 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5961 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5962 *
5963 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5964 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5965 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5966 * the key that's being replaced.
5967 */
5968struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5969ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5970			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5971			int link_id);
5972
5973/**
5974 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5975 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5976 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5977 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5978 * @gfp: allocation flags
5979 */
5980void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5981				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5982
5983/**
5984 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5985 *
5986 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5987 * at the same time.
5988 *
5989 * @keyconf: the key in question
5990 */
5991void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5992
5993/**
5994 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5995 *
5996 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5997 * at the same time.
5998 *
5999 * @keyconf: the key in question
6000 */
6001void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6002
6003/**
6004 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6005 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6006 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6007 *
6008 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6009 */
6010void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6011
6012/**
6013 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6014 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6015 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6016 *
6017 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6018 */
6019void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6020
6021/**
6022 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6023 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6024 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6025 *
6026 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6027 *
6028 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6029 */
6030
6031int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6032
6033/**
6034 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6035 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6036 *
6037 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6038 */
6039void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6040
6041/**
6042 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6043 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6044 *
6045 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6046 */
6047void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6048
6049/**
6050 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6051 *
6052 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6053 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6054 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6055 * any context, including hardirq context.
6056 *
6057 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6058 * @info: information about the completed scan
6059 */
6060void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6061			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6062
6063/**
6064 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6065 *
6066 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6067 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6068 *
6069 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6070 */
6071void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6072
6073/**
6074 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6075 *
6076 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6077 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6078 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6079 * while associating, for instance.
6080 *
6081 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6082 */
6083void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6084
6085/**
6086 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6087 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6088 *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6089 *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6090 *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6091 *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6092 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6093 *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6094 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6095 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6096 *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6097 *	for instance.
6098 */
6099enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6100	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
6101	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
6102	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
6103	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
6104};
6105
6106/**
6107 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6108 *
6109 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6110 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6111 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6112 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6113 *
6114 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6115 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6116 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6117 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6118 */
6119void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6120				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6121						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6122				  void *data);
6123
6124/**
6125 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6126 *
6127 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6128 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6129 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6130 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6131 * be used.
6132 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6133 *
6134 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6135 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6136 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6137 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6138 */
6139static inline void
6140ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6141				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6142						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6143				    void *data)
6144{
6145	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6146				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6147				     iterator, data);
6148}
6149
6150/**
6151 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6152 *
6153 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6154 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6155 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6156 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6157 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6158 *
6159 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6160 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6161 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6162 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6163 */
6164void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6165						u32 iter_flags,
6166						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6167						    u8 *mac,
6168						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6169						void *data);
6170
6171/**
6172 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6173 *
6174 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6175 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6176 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
 
 
 
6177 *
6178 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6179 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6180 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6181 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6182 */
6183void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6184					     u32 iter_flags,
6185					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6186						u8 *mac,
6187						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6188					     void *data);
6189
6190/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
6191 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6192 *
6193 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6194 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6195 * function for them.
6196 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6197 *
6198 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6199 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6200 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6201 */
6202void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6203				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6204						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6205				       void *data);
6206/**
6207 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6208 *
6209 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6210 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6211 *
6212 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6213 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6214 */
6215void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6216
6217/**
6218 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6219 *
6220 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6221 * workqueue.
6222 *
6223 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6224 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6225 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6226 */
6227void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6228				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6229				  unsigned long delay);
6230
6231/**
6232 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6233 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6234 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6235 *
6236 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6237 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6238 * mac80211.
6239 *
6240 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6241 */
6242void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6243					    u16 tid);
6244
6245/**
6246 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6247 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6248 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6249 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6250 *
6251 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6252 *
6253 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6254 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6255 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6256 */
6257int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6258				  u16 timeout);
6259
6260/**
6261 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6262 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6263 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6264 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6265 *
6266 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6267 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6268 * from any context.
6269 */
6270void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6271				      u16 tid);
6272
6273/**
6274 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6275 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6276 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6277 *
6278 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6279 *
6280 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6281 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6282 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6283 */
6284int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6285
6286/**
6287 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6288 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6289 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6290 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6291 *
6292 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6293 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6294 * can be called from any context.
6295 */
6296void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6297				     u16 tid);
6298
6299/**
6300 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6301 *
6302 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6303 * @addr: station's address
6304 *
6305 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6306 *
6307 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6308 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6309 */
6310struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6311					 const u8 *addr);
6312
6313/**
6314 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6315 *
6316 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6317 * @addr: remote station's address
6318 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6319 *
6320 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6321 *
6322 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6323 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6324 *
6325 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6326 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6327 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6328 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6329 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6330 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6331 *      is not reliable.
6332 *
6333 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6334 */
6335struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6336					       const u8 *addr,
6337					       const u8 *localaddr);
6338
6339/**
6340 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6341 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6342 * @addr: remote station's link address
6343 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6344 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6345 *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6346 *
6347 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6348 */
6349struct ieee80211_sta *
6350ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6351				 const u8 *addr,
6352				 const u8 *localaddr,
6353				 unsigned int *link_id);
6354
6355/**
6356 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6357 * @hw: the hardware
6358 * @pubsta: the station
6359 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6360 *
6361 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6362 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6363 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6364 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6365 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6366 *
6367 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6368 * manner.
6369 *
6370 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6371 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6372 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6373 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6374 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6375 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6376 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6377 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6378 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6379 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6380 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6381 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6382 * woke up while blocked or not.
6383 */
6384void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6385			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6386
6387/**
6388 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6389 * @pubsta: the station
6390 *
6391 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6392 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6393 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6394 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6395 *
6396 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6397 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6398 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6399 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6400 *
6401 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6402 *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6403 *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6404 *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6405 */
6406void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6407
6408/**
6409 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6410 * @pubsta: the station
6411 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6412 *
6413 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6414 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6415 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6416 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6417 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6418 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6419 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6420 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6421 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6422 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6423 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6424 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6425 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6426 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6427 */
6428void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6429
6430/**
6431 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6432 * @pubsta: the station
6433 *
6434 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6435 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6436 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6437 *
6438 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6439 * there is no need to call this function.
6440 */
6441void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6442
6443/**
6444 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6445 *
6446 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6447 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6448 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6449 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6450 *
6451 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6452 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6453 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6454 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6455 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6456 * attempts.
6457 *
6458 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6459 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6460 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6461 * them to 0.
6462 *
6463 * @pubsta: the station
6464 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6465 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6466 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6467 */
6468void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6469				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6470
6471/**
6472 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6473 *
6474 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6475 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6476 *
6477 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6478 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6479 */
6480bool
6481ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6482
6483/**
6484 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6485 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6486 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6487 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6488 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6489 *
6490 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6491 *
6492 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6493 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6494 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6495 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
 
 
6496 *
6497 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6498 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6499 * set_key callback.
6500 */
6501void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6502			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6503			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6504				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6505				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6506				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6507				      void *data),
6508			 void *iter_data);
6509
6510/**
6511 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6512 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6513 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6514 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6515 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6516 *
6517 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6518 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6519 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6520 * in removal process will be skipped.
6521 *
6522 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6523 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6524 */
6525void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6526			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6527			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6528					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6529					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6530					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6531					  void *data),
6532			     void *iter_data);
6533
6534/**
6535 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6536 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6537 * @iter: iterator function
6538 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6539 *
6540 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6541 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6542 * places while calling into the driver.
6543 *
6544 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6545 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6546 * removed.
6547 *
6548 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6549 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6550 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6551 * or not.
6552 */
6553void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6554	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6555	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6556		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6557		     void *data),
6558	void *iter_data);
6559
6560/**
6561 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6562 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6563 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6564 *
6565 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6566 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6567 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6568 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6569 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6570 * %NULL.
6571 *
6572 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6573 */
6574struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6575					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6576
6577/**
6578 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6579 *
6580 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6581 *
6582 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6583 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6584 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6585 */
6586void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6587
6588/**
6589 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6590 *
6591 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6592 *
6593 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6594 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6595 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6596 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6597 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6598 *
6599 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6600 * without connection recovery attempts.
6601 */
6602void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6603
6604/**
6605 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6606 *
6607 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6608 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6609 *
6610 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6611 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6612 */
6613void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6614
6615/**
6616 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6617 *
6618 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6619 *
6620 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6621 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6622 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6623 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6624 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6625 *
6626 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6627 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6628 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6629 * disconnect normally later.
6630 *
6631 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6632 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6633 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6634 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6635 */
6636void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6637
6638/**
6639 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6640 * hardware restart
6641 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6642 *
6643 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6644 * hardware restart.
6645 */
6646void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6647
6648/**
6649 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6650 *	rssi threshold triggered
6651 *
6652 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6653 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6654 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6655 * @gfp: context flags
6656 *
6657 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6658 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6659 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6660 */
6661void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6662			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6663			       s32 rssi_level,
6664			       gfp_t gfp);
6665
6666/**
6667 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6668 *
6669 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6670 * @gfp: context flags
6671 */
6672void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6673
6674/**
6675 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6676 *
6677 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6678 */
6679void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6680
6681/**
6682 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6683 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6684 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6685 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6686 *	false.
6687 *
6688 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6689 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6690 */
6691void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6692			     unsigned int link_id);
6693
6694/**
6695 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6696 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6697 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6698 *
6699 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6700 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6701 * a deauth frame in this case.
6702 */
6703void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6704					 bool block_tx);
6705
6706/**
6707 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6708 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6709 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6710 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6711 *
6712 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6713 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6714 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6715 */
6716void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6717			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6718
6719/**
6720 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6721 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6722 */
6723void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6724
6725/**
6726 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6727 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6728 */
6729void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6730
6731/**
6732 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6733 *
6734 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6735 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6736 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6737 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6738 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6739 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6740 *
6741 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6742 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6743 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6744 */
6745void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6746				  const u8 *addr);
6747
6748/**
6749 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6750 * @pubsta: station struct
6751 * @tid: the session's TID
6752 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6753 *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6754 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6755 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6756 *
6757 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6758 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6759 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6760 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6761 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6762 */
6763void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6764					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6765					  u16 received_mpdus);
6766
6767/**
6768 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6769 *
6770 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6771 * buffer.
6772 *
6773 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6774 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6775 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6776 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6777 */
6778void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6779
6780/**
6781 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6782 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6783 * @addr: station mac address
6784 * @tid: the rx tid
6785 */
6786void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6787				 unsigned int tid);
6788
6789/**
6790 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6791 *
6792 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6793 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6794 * reordering.
6795 *
6796 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6797 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6798 *
6799 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6800 * @addr: station mac address
6801 * @tid: the rx tid
6802 */
6803static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6804						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6805{
6806	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6807		return;
6808	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6809}
6810
6811/**
6812 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6813 *
6814 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6815 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6816 * reordering.
6817 *
6818 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6819 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6820 *
6821 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6822 * @addr: station mac address
6823 * @tid: the rx tid
6824 */
6825static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6826						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6827{
6828	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6829		return;
6830	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6831}
6832
6833/**
6834 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6835 *
6836 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6837 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6838 *
6839 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6840 *
6841 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6842 * @addr: station mac address
6843 * @tid: the rx tid
6844 */
6845void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6846				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6847
6848/* Rate control API */
6849
6850/**
6851 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6852 *
6853 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6854 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6855 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6856 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6857 *	to be filled in
6858 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6859 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6860 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6861 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6862 *	RTS threshold
6863 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6864 *	if the selected rate supports it
6865 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6866 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6867 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6868 */
6869struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6870	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6871	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6872	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6873	struct sk_buff *skb;
6874	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6875	bool rts, short_preamble;
6876	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6877	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6878	bool bss;
6879};
6880
6881/**
6882 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6883 */
6884enum rate_control_capabilities {
6885	/**
6886	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6887	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6888	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6889	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6890	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6891	 */
6892	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6893	/**
6894	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6895	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6896	 */
6897	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6898};
6899
6900struct rate_control_ops {
6901	unsigned long capa;
6902	const char *name;
6903	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6904	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6905			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6906	void (*free)(void *priv);
6907
6908	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6909	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6910			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6911			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6912	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6913			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6914			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6915			    u32 changed);
6916	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6917			 void *priv_sta);
6918
6919	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6920			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6921			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6922	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6923			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6924			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6925	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6926			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6927
6928	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6929				struct dentry *dir);
6930
6931	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6932};
6933
6934static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6935				 enum nl80211_band band,
6936				 int index)
6937{
6938	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6939}
6940
6941static inline s8
6942rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6943		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6944{
6945	int i;
6946
6947	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6948		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6949			return i;
6950
6951	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6952	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6953
6954	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6955	return 0;
6956}
6957
6958static inline
6959bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6960			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6961{
6962	unsigned int i;
6963
6964	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6965		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6966			return true;
6967	return false;
6968}
6969
6970/**
6971 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6972 *
6973 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6974 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6975 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6976 * the most recent rate control module decision.
6977 *
6978 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6979 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6980 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6981 */
6982int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6983			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6984			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6985
6986int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6987void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6988
6989static inline bool
6990conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6991{
6992	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6993}
6994
6995static inline bool
6996conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6997{
6998	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6999	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7000}
7001
7002static inline bool
7003conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7004{
7005	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7006	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7007}
7008
7009static inline bool
7010conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7011{
7012	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7013}
7014
7015static inline bool
7016conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7017{
7018	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7019		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7020		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7021}
7022
7023static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7024ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7025{
7026	if (p2p) {
7027		switch (type) {
7028		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7029			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7030		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7031			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7032		default:
7033			break;
7034		}
7035	}
7036	return type;
7037}
7038
7039static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7040ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7041{
7042	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7043}
7044
7045/**
7046 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7047 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7048 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7049 *
7050 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7051 */
7052static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
7053ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7054				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7055{
7056	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7057}
7058
7059/**
7060 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7061 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7062 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7063 *
7064 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7065 */
7066static inline __le16
7067ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7068			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7069{
7070	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7071}
7072
7073/**
7074 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7075 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7076 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7077 *
7078 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7079 */
7080static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
7081ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7082				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7083{
7084	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7085}
7086
7087/**
7088 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7089 *
7090 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7091 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7092 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7093 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7094 *
7095 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7096 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7097 * matching GroupId management frame.
7098 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7099 */
7100void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7101				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7102
7103void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7104				   int rssi_min_thold,
7105				   int rssi_max_thold);
7106
7107void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7108
7109/**
7110 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7111 *
7112 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7113 *
7114 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7115 *
7116 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7117 * applicable.
7118 */
7119int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7120
7121/**
7122 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7123 * @vif: virtual interface
7124 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7125 * @gfp: allocation flags
7126 *
7127 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7128 */
7129void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7130				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7131				    gfp_t gfp);
7132
7133/**
7134 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7135 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7136 * @vif: virtual interface
7137 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7138 * @band: the band to transmit on
7139 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7140 *
7141 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7142 */
7143bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7144			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7145			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7146
7147/**
7148 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7149 *				 of injected frames.
7150 *
7151 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7152 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7153 * of the skb before calling this function.
7154 *
7155 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7156 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7157 */
7158bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7159				 struct net_device *dev);
7160
7161/**
7162 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7163 *
7164 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7165 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7166 *
7167 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7168 *
7169 * private:
7170 *
7171 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7172 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7173 */
7174struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7175	u32 next_tsf;
7176	bool has_next_tsf;
7177
7178	u8 absent;
7179
7180	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7181	struct {
7182		u32 start;
7183		u32 duration;
7184		u32 interval;
7185	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7186};
7187
7188/**
7189 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7190 *
7191 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7192 * @data: NoA tracking data
7193 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7194 *
7195 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7196 */
7197int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7198			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7199
7200/**
7201 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7202 *
7203 * @data: NoA tracking data
7204 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7205 */
7206void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7207
7208/**
7209 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7210 * @vif: virtual interface
7211 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7212 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7213 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7214 * @gfp: allocation flags
7215 *
7216 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7217 */
7218void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7219				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7220				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7221
7222/**
7223 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7224 *
7225 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7226 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7227 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7228 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7229 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7230 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7231 *
7232 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7233 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7234 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7235 *
7236 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7237 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7238 *
7239 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7240 */
7241int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7242
7243/**
7244 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7245 *
7246 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7247 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7248 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7249 *
7250 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7251 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7252 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7253 *
7254 * @sta: the station
7255 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7256 */
7257void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7258
7259/**
7260 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7261 *
7262 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7263 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7264 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7265 *
7266 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7267 *
7268 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7269 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7270 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7271 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7272 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7273 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7274 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7275 *
7276 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7277 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7278 */
7279struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7280				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7281
7282/**
7283 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7284 * (in process context)
7285 *
7286 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7287 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7288 *
7289 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7290 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7291 *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7292 */
7293static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7294						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7295{
7296	struct sk_buff *skb;
7297
7298	local_bh_disable();
7299	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7300	local_bh_enable();
7301
7302	return skb;
7303}
7304
7305/**
7306 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7307 *
7308 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7309 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7310 *
7311 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7312 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7313 */
7314void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7315				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7316
7317/**
7318 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7319 *
7320 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7321 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7322 *
7323 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7324 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7325 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7326 */
7327struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7328
7329/**
7330 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7331 *
7332 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7333 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7334 *
7335 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7336 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7337 */
7338void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7339
7340/* (deprecated) */
7341static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7342{
7343}
7344
7345void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7346			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7347
7348/**
7349 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7350 *
7351 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7352 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7353 *
7354 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7355 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7356 *
7357 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7358 * this TXQ internally.
7359 */
7360static inline void
7361ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7362{
7363	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7364}
7365
7366/**
7367 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7368 *
7369 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7370 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7371 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7372 *
7373 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7374 * internally.
7375 */
7376static inline void
7377ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7378		     bool force)
7379{
7380	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7381}
7382
7383/**
7384 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7385 *
7386 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7387 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7388 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7389 * next_txq().
7390 *
7391 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7392 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7393 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7394 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7395 * again.
7396 *
7397 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7398 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7399 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7400 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7401 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7402 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7403 *
7404 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7405 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7406 */
7407bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7408				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7409
7410/**
7411 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7412 *
7413 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7414 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7415 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7416 *
7417 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7418 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7419 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7420 */
7421void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7422			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7423			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7424
7425/**
7426 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7427 *
7428 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7429 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7430 *
7431 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7432 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7433 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7434 * @gfp: allocation flags
7435 */
7436void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7437				   u8 inst_id,
7438				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7439				   gfp_t gfp);
7440
7441/**
7442 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7443 *
7444 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7445 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7446 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7447 *
7448 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7449 * @match: match event information
7450 * @gfp: allocation flags
7451 */
7452void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7453			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7454			      gfp_t gfp);
7455
7456/**
7457 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7458 *
7459 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7460 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7461 *
7462 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7463 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7464 *          information.
7465 * @len: frame length in bytes
7466 */
7467u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7468			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7469			      int len);
7470
7471/**
7472 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7473 *
7474 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7475 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7476 *
7477 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7478 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7479 * @len: frame length in bytes
7480 */
7481u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7482			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7483			      int len);
7484/**
7485 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7486 *
7487 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7488 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7489 * hardware or firmware.
7490 *
7491 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7492 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7493 */
7494bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7495
7496/**
7497 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7498 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7499 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7500 *
7501 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7502 *
7503 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7504 */
7505struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7506						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7507
7508/**
7509 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7510 *	probe response template.
7511 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7512 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7513 *
7514 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7515 *
7516 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7517 */
7518struct sk_buff *
7519ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7520					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7521
7522/**
7523 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7524 * collision.
7525 *
7526 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7527 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7528 *	aware of.
 
7529 */
7530void
7531ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7532				      u64 color_bitmap);
7533
7534/**
7535 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7536 *
7537 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7538 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7539 *
7540 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7541 */
7542static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7543{
7544	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7545	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7546
7547	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7548	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7549}
7550
7551/**
7552 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7553 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7554 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7555 *
7556 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7557 *	back into the driver.
7558 *
7559 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7560 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7561 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7562 *
7563 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7564 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7565 * a sequence of calls like
7566 *
7567 *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7568 *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7569 *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7570 *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7571 *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7572 *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7573 *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7574 *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7575 *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
 
 
 
 
7576 */
7577int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7578
7579/**
7580 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7581 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7582 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7583 *
7584 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7585 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7586 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7587 * completed after it returns.
7588 */
7589void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7590				      u16 active_links);
7591
7592/* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7593int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7594				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7595void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7596				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7597void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7598				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7599				      u32 changed);
7600int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7601					 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7602					 int n_vifs,
7603					 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7604
7605#endif /* MAC80211_H */